blob: eea9563462c05effbfae256b0bf73f323f6cb956 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau1ce7d492021-06-17 09:06:08 +02007 2021/06/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200749In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
750regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
751only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
752
753* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
754
755* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
756 starting at one.
757
758* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
759 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
760 first section.
761
762These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
763if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
764section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
765"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
766proxies.
767
768This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
769logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
770to name some config objects like servers for example.
771
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200772See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200773
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100774
7752.4. Conditional blocks
776-----------------------
777
778It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
779some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
780ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
781configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
782versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
783preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
784text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
785lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
786switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
787are defined to form conditional blocks:
788
789 - .if <condition>
790 - .elif <condition>
791 - .else
792 - .endif
793
794The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
795as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
796matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
797there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
798only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
799".elif" of a block.
800
801Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
802ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
803as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
804
805The conditions are currently limited to:
806
807 - an empty string, always returns "false"
808 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
809 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200810 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
811
812The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
813
814 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
815 exists, regardless of its contents
816
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200817 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
818 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
819 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
820
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200821 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
822 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
823
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200824 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
825 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
826 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
827 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
828
829 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
830 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
831 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
832 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
833
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200834Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100835
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200836 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
837 listen mwcli_px
838 bind :1111
839 ...
840 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100841
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200842 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
843 bind :80
844 .endif
845
846 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200847 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200848 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200849 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200850 .endif
851
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200852 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
853 profiling.memory on
854 .endif
855
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200856Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100857
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200858 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100859 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
860 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
861 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
862
863Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
864"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
865fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
866provide advice to the user.
867
868Example:
869
870 .if "${A}"
871 .if "${B}"
872 .notice "A=1, B=1"
873 .elif "${C}"
874 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
875 .elif "${D}"
876 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
877 .else
878 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
879 .endif
880 .else
881 .notice "A=0"
882 .endif
883
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200884 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
885 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
886
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100887
8882.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200889----------------
890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100891Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100892values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
893otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
894numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
895for every keyword. Supported units are :
896
897 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
898 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
899 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
900 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
901 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
902 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
903
904
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009052.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200906-------------
907
908 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
909 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
910 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
911 global
912 daemon
913 maxconn 256
914
915 defaults
916 mode http
917 timeout connect 5000ms
918 timeout client 50000ms
919 timeout server 50000ms
920
921 frontend http-in
922 bind *:80
923 default_backend servers
924
925 backend servers
926 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
927
928
929 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
930 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
931 global
932 daemon
933 maxconn 256
934
935 defaults
936 mode http
937 timeout connect 5000ms
938 timeout client 50000ms
939 timeout server 50000ms
940
941 listen http-in
942 bind *:80
943 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
944
945
946Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
947
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100948 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200949
950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009513. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952--------------------
953
954Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
955are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
956of them have command-line equivalents.
957
958The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
959
960 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200961 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200962 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200963 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200964 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200966 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200967 - description
968 - deviceatlas-json-file
969 - deviceatlas-log-level
970 - deviceatlas-separator
971 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200972 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900973 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200974 - gid
975 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100976 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200977 - h1-case-adjust
978 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100979 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100980 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100981 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200982 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200983 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200984 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100985 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200986 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100987 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100988 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200989 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200990 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200991 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200992 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +0100993 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200995 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100996 - presetenv
997 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998 - uid
999 - ulimit-n
1000 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001001 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001002 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001003 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001004 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001005 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001006 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001007 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001008 - ssl-default-bind-options
1009 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001010 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001011 - ssl-default-server-options
1012 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001013 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001014 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001015 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001016 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001017 - 51degrees-data-file
1018 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001019 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001020 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001021 - wurfl-data-file
1022 - wurfl-information-list
1023 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001024 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001025 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001026
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001027 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001028 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001029 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001030 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001031 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001032 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001033 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001034 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001035 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001036 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001037 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001038 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001039 - noepoll
1040 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001041 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001042 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001043 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001044 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001045 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001046 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001047 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001048 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001049 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001050 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001051 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001052 - tune.buffers.limit
1053 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001054 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001055 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001056 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001057 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001058 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001059 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001060 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001061 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001062 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001063 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001064 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001065 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001066 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001067 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001068 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1069 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001070 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001071 - tune.maxaccept
1072 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001073 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001074 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001075 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001076 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1077 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001078 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1079 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001080 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001081 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001082 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001083 - tune.sndbuf.client
1084 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001085 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001086 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001087 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001088 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001089 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001090 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001091 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001092 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001093 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001094 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001095 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1096 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1097 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001098 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1099 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001100
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001101 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001103 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001104
1105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011063.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001107------------------------------------
1108
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001109ca-base <dir>
1110 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001111 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1112 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1113 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001114
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001115chroot <jail dir>
1116 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1117 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1118 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1119 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1120 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001121 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001122
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001123cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1124 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1125 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1126 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1127 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1128 set. These sets have the format
1129
1130 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1131
1132 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001133 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001134 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1135 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001136 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1137 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001138 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1139 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1140 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1141 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1142 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1143 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1144 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1145 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1146 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1147 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001148
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001149 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1150 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1151 on the machine's word size.
1152
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001153 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001154 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1155 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1156 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1157 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1158 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1159 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001160
1161 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001162 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1163
1164 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1165 # first 4 CPUs
1166
1167 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1168 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1169 # word size.
1170
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001171 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001172 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001173 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1174 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1175 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1176
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001177 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1178 # and so on.
1179 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1180 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1181 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1182
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001183 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001184 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1185 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1186 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1187
1188 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1189 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1190 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1191
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001192 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1193 # and a thread range.
1194 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1195 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1196 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1197
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001198crt-base <dir>
1199 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001200 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1201 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001202
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001203daemon
1204 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1205 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001206 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1207 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001208
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001209default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001210 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001211 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1212 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1213 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1214 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1215 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1216 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1217 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1218 not start with a slash ('/'):
1219 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1220 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1221
1222 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1223 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1224 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1225 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1226 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1227 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1228 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1229 each of them.
1230
1231 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1232 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1233 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1234 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1235 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1236 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1237 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1238 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1239
1240 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1241 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001242 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001243 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1244 made easily relocatable.
1245
1246 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1247 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1248 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1249 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1250 consistent across all configuration files.
1251
1252 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1253 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1254 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1255 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1256 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1257 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1258 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1259 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1260
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001261deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1262 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001263 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001264
1265deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001266 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001267 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1268
1269deviceatlas-separator <char>
1270 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1271 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1272
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001273deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001274 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1275 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1276 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001277
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001278expose-experimental-directives
1279 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1280 the config file will be rejected.
1281
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001282external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001283 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1284 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001285 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1286 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1287 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1288 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1289 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001290
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001291gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001292 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001293 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1294 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001295 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001296 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001297 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001298
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001299group <group name>
1300 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1301 See also "gid" and "user".
1302
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001303hard-stop-after <time>
1304 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1305
1306 Arguments :
1307 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1308 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1309 SIGUSR1 signal.
1310
1311 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1312 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1313 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1314
1315 Example:
1316 global
1317 hard-stop-after 30s
1318
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001319h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1320 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1321 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1322 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1323 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001324 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001325 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1326 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1327 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1328 specified in a proxy.
1329
1330 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1331 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1332 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1333 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1334 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1335 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1336 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1337
1338 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1339 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1340 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1341 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1342 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1343
1344 Example:
1345 global
1346 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1347
1348 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1349 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1350
1351h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1352 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1353 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1354 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1355 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1356 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1357 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1358 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1359 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1360
1361 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1362 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1363 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1364
1365 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1366 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1367
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001368insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001369 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001370 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1371 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1372 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1373 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1374 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1375 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1376 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001377 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001378 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1379 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1380 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1381 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1382 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1383 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1384 disable it.
1385
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001386insecure-setuid-wanted
1387 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1388 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1389 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1390 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001391 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001392 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001393 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001394 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1395 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001396 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001397 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1398 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1399 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1400 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1401
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001402issuers-chain-path <dir>
1403 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1404 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1405 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001406 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001407 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1408 "issuers-chain-path".
1409 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1410 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1411 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1412 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1413 will share the chain in memory.
1414
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001415localpeer <name>
1416 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1417 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1418 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1419 the configuration parsing.
1420
1421 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1422 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1423
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001424log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001425 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001426 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001427 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001428 configured with "log global".
1429
1430 <address> can be one of:
1431
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001432 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001433 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1434 port).
1435
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001436 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1437 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1438 port).
1439
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001440 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001441 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1442 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001443 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001444
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001445 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1446 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1447 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1448 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1449 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1450 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1451 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1452 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1453 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1454 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001455 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001456 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1457 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1458 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001459 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1460 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001461
1462 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1463 "fd@2", see above.
1464
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001465 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1466 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1467 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1468 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1469 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1470
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001471 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1472 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001473
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001474 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1475 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1476 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1477 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1478 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1479 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1480 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1481 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1482 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1483 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001484 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1485 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001486
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001487 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1488 one of the following :
1489
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001490 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1491 field is stripped. This is the default.
1492 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1493 rfc3164.
1494
1495 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001496 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1497
1498 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1499 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1500
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001501 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1502 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1503 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1504 designed to be used with a local log server.
1505
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001506 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1507 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1508 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1509 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1510 logger consumes.
1511
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001512 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1513 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1514 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1515 used with a local log server.
1516
1517 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1518 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1519 designed to be used with a local log server.
1520
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001521 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1522 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1523 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1524 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1525
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001526 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1527 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1528 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1529 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1530 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1531
1532 <sample_size>
1533 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1534 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1535 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1536 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1537 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1538
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001539 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001540
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001541 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1542 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1543 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1544
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001545 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1546 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1547 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1548 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001549
1550 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001551 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1552 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1553 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1554 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1555 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1556 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001557
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001558 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001559
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001560log-send-hostname [<string>]
1561 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1562 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1563 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1564 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1565 the logs.
1566
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001567log-tag <string>
1568 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1569 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1570 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001571 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001572
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001573lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001574 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1575 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1576 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1577 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1578 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1579 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001580 used multiple times.
1581
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001582lua-load-per-thread <file>
1583 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1584 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1585 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1586 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1587 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1588 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1589 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1590 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1591 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1592 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1593 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1594 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1595 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1596 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1597 times.
1598
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001599lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1600 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1601 variable.
1602 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1603 to "path".
1604
1605 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1606 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1607 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1608 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1609 will be checked earlier.
1610
1611 As an example by specifying the following path:
1612
1613 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1614 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1615
1616 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1617 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1618 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1619 paths if that does not exist either.
1620
1621 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1622 documentation.
1623
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001624master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001625 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1626 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1627 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001628 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001629 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1630 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001631 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1632 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1633 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1634 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1635 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001636
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001637 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001638
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001639mworker-max-reloads <number>
1640 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001641 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001642 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1643 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1644 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1645
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001646nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001647 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1648 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1649 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001650 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1651 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001652 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1653 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1654 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001655
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001656nbthread <number>
1657 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001658 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001659 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1660 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1661 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1662 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001663 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1664 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1665 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1666 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1667 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1668 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1669 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001670
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001671numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001672 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001673 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1674 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1675 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1676 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1677 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1678 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1679 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1680 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1681
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001682pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001683 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1684 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1685 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1686 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001687
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001688pp2-never-send-local
1689 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1690 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1691 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1692 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1693 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1694 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1695 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1696 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1697 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1698 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1699 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1700
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001701presetenv <name> <value>
1702 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1703 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1704 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1705 and "unsetenv".
1706
1707resetenv [<name> ...]
1708 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1709 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1710 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1711 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1712 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1713 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1714 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1715 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001717stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001718 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1719 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1720 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1721 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1722 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1723 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001724 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001725 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1726 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1727 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1728 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001729
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001730server-state-base <directory>
1731 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001732 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1733 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001734
1735server-state-file <file>
1736 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1737 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1738 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1739 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1740 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1741 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1742 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1743 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001744 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1745 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001746
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001747set-var <var-name> <expr>
1748 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1749 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1750 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1751 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1752 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1753 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1754 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1755 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1756 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1757
1758 Example:
1759 global
1760 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1761 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1762 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1763
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001764setenv <name> <value>
1765 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1766 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1767 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1768 and "unsetenv".
1769
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001770set-dumpable
1771 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001772 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1773 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1774 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1775 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1776 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1777 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1778 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1779 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1780 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1781 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1782 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1783 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1784 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1785 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1786 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001787 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001788 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001789
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001790ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1791 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1792 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001793 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001794 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001795 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1796 information and recommendations see e.g.
1797 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1798 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1799 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1800 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001801
1802ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1803 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1804 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1805 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1806 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1807 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001808 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1809 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1810 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001811 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001812
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001813ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1814 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1815 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1816 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1817 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1818 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1819
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001820ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1822 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1823 keyword to see available options.
1824
1825 Example:
1826 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001827 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001828
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001829ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1830 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1831 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001832 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001833 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001834 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1835 information and recommendations see e.g.
1836 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1837 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1838 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1839 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1840 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001841
1842ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1843 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1844 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1845 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1846 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1847 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001848 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1849 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1850 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1851 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001852
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001853ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1854 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1855 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1856 keyword to see available options.
1857
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001858ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1860 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1861 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001862 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001863 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001864 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1865 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1866 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1867 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001868 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1869 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1870 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1871
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001872ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1873 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1874 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001875 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001876 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001877 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1878
1879 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001880
1881 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1882 and won't try to remove them.
1883
1884 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1885
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001886ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001887 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001888 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1889 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1890 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001891
1892 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1893 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1894 optimize the startup time.
1895
1896 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1897 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1898 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1899
1900 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001901 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001902
1903 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001904 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1905 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001906
1907 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1908 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1909 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1910 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1911 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001912 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001913
1914 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001915 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001916 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1917 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1918 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1919 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1920 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001921 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001922
1923 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1924
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001925 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001926 a cert bundle.
1927
1928 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1929 separately in several "crt".
1930
1931 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1932 since files are loading separately.
1933
1934 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1935 required to commit them.
1936
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001937 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001938 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001939
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001940 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1941 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1942 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001943
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001944 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1945 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1946 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001947
1948 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001949 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1950 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001951
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001952 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1953 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1954
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001955 The default behavior is "all".
1956
1957 Example:
1958 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1959 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1960 ssl-load-extra-files none
1961
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001962 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1963 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001964
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001965ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1966 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1967 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1968 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1969
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001970ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001971 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001972 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1973 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1974 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1975 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1976 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1977 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001978 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001979
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001980stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1981 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1982 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1983 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001984 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001985 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001986
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001987 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1988 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1989 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001990
1991stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1992 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1993 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001994 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001995
1996stats maxconn <connections>
1997 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1998 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1999
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002000uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002001 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002002 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2003 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2004 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2005
2006ulimit-n <number>
2007 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2008 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2009 option.
2010
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002011unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2012 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2013
2014 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2015 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2016 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2017 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2018 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002019 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002020 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2021 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2022 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2023 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2024
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002025unsetenv [<name> ...]
2026 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2027 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2028 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2029 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2030 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2031 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2032 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2033
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002034user <user name>
2035 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2036 See also "uid" and "group".
2037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002038node <name>
2039 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2040
2041 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2042 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2043 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2044 traffic.
2045
2046description <text>
2047 Add a text that describes the instance.
2048
2049 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2050 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2051 "<" and ">" characters.
2052
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100205351degrees-data-file <file path>
2054 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002055 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002056
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002057 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002058 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2059
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000206051degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002061 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2062 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2063 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2064
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002065 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002066 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2067
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200206851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002069 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2070 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2071
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002072 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002073 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2074
207551degrees-cache-size <number>
2076 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2077 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2078 By default, this cache is disabled.
2079
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002080 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002081 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2082
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002083wurfl-data-file <file path>
2084 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2085 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2086
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002087 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002088 with USE_WURFL=1.
2089
2090wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2091 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2092 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2093 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2094
2095 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2096
2097 Valid WURFL properties are:
2098 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2099
2100 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2101 device.
2102
2103 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2104 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2105
2106 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2107 particular web request.
2108
2109 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2110 used Libwurfl API version.
2111
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002112 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2113 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2114
2115 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2116 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2117
2118 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2119
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002120 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002121 with USE_WURFL=1.
2122
2123wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2124 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2125 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2126
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002127 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002128 with USE_WURFL=1.
2129
2130wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2131 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2132 thus before the chroot.
2133
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002134 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002135 with USE_WURFL=1.
2136
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002137wurfl-cache-size <size>
2138 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2139 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002140 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002141 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002142
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002143 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002144 with USE_WURFL=1.
2145
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002146strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002147 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002148 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2149 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002150 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002151 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021533.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002154-----------------------
2155
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002156busy-polling
2157 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2158 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2159 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2160 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2161 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2162 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2163 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2164 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2165 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2166 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2167 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2168 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2169 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2170 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2171 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2172 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2173 "poll" pollers.
2174
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002175 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2176 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2177 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2178
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002179max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002180 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002181 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2182 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2183 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2184 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2185 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2186 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2187 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2188
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002189maxconn <number>
2190 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2191 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2192 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002193 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2194 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2195 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2196 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002197 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2198 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2199 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2200 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2201 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2202 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002203
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002204maxconnrate <number>
2205 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2206 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2207 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2208 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2209 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2210 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2211 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2212 fairness.
2213
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002214maxcomprate <number>
2215 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002216 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002217 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2218 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2219 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002220 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002221 default value.
2222
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002223maxcompcpuusage <number>
2224 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2225 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2226 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002227 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. In
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002228 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2229 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2230 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2231 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2232
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002233maxpipes <number>
2234 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2235 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2236 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2237 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2238 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2239 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2240
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002241maxsessrate <number>
2242 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2243 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2244 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2245 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2246 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2247 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2248 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2249 fairness.
2250
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002251maxsslconn <number>
2252 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2253 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2254 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2255 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2256 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2257 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2258 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002259 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2260 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2261 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2262 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002263 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002264 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2265 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002266
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002267maxsslrate <number>
2268 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2269 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2270 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2271 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2272 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2273 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2274 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2275 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2276 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2277 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2278
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002279maxzlibmem <number>
2280 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2281 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2282 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002283 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2284 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2285 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2286
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002287noepoll
2288 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2289 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002290 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002291
2292nokqueue
2293 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2294 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2295 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2296
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002297noevports
2298 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2299 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2300 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2301 also "nopoll".
2302
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002303nopoll
2304 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2305 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002306 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002307 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2308 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002309
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002310nosplice
2311 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002312 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002313 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002314 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002315 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2316 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2317 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2318 "option splice-response".
2319
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002320nogetaddrinfo
2321 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2322 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2323
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002324noreuseport
2325 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2326 command line argument "-dR".
2327
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002328profiling.memory { on | off }
2329 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2330 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2331 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2332 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2333 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2334 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2335 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2336 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2337 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2338
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002339profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2340 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2341 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2342 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2343 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002344 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002345 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2346 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2347 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2348 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2349
2350 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2351 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2352 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2353 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2354 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002355 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2356 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2357 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2358 CLI.
2359
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002360spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002361 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2362 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2363 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2364 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2365 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2366 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002368ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002369 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002370 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002371 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002372 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002373 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2374 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2375 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002376 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2377 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002378 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2379 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2380 openssl configuration file uses:
2381 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2382
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002383ssl-mode-async
2384 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002385 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002386 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2387 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002388 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002389 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002390 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002391
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002392tune.buffers.limit <number>
2393 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2394 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2395 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2396 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2397 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002398 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002399 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2400 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2401 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2402 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2403 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2404 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2405 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2406 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002407 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002408
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002409tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2410 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2411 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2412 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002413 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002414
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002415tune.bufsize <number>
2416 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2417 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2418 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2419 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2420 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2421 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2422 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002423 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2424 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002425 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002426 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002427 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002428 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2429 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002430
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002431tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2432 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002433
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002434tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2435 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2436 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2437 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2438 this value. The default value is 1.
2439
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002440tune.fail-alloc
2441 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2442 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2443 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2444 gracefully.
2445
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002446tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2447 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2448 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2449 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2450 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2451 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2452
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002453tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2454 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2455 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2456 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2457 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2458 change it.
2459
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002460tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2461 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002462 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002463 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002464 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2465 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2466 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2467 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2468 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2469
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002470tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2471 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2472 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2473 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2474 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2475 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002476 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002477 recommended not to change this value.
2478
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002479tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002480 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002481 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002482 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002483 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2484 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2485 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2486 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2487
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002488tune.http.cookielen <number>
2489 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2490 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2491 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2492 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2493 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2494 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2495 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2496 to change this value.
2497
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002498tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002499 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2500 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002501 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002502 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002503 configuration directives too.
2504 The default value is 1024.
2505
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002506tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2507 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2508 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2509 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2510 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2511 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2512 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002513 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2514 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2515 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002516
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002517tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2518 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2519 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2520 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2521 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2522 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2523 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002524 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2525 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2526 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2527 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2528 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002529
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002530tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002531 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002532 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2533 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2534 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2535 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002536 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002537 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002538 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002539 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2540
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002541tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2542 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2543 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2544 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2545 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2546 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2547 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2548 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2549 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2550 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2551
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002552tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2553 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002554 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002555 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2556 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002557 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002558 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2559 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2560
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002561tune.lua.maxmem
2562 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2563 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2564 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2565 memory.
2566
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002567tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2568 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002569 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2570 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002571 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002572
2573tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2574 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2575 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2576 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2577 check servers.
2578
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002579tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2580 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2581 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2582 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002583 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002584
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002585tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002586 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2587 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002588 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2589 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2590 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2591 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2592 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2593 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2594 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2595 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2596 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002597
2598tune.maxpollevents <number>
2599 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2600 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2601 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2602 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2603 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2604
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002605tune.maxrewrite <number>
2606 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2607 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2608 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2609 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2610 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2611 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2612 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2613 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2614 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2615 bufsize.
2616
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002617tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2618 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2619 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2620 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2621 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2622 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2623 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2624 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2625 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2626 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002627 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2628 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002629 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2630 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2631 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2632 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2633 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2634 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2635 setting this parameter to 0.
2636
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002637tune.pipesize <number>
2638 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2639 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2640 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2641 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2642 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2643 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2644
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002645tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2646 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002647 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002648 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2649 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2650 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2651 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002652 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002653
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002654tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2655 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002656 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002657 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2658 default is 20.
2659
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002660tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2661tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2662 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2663 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2664 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002665 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002666 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002667 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2668 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2669
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002670tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002671 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002672 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2673 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2674 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2675 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2676
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002677tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002678 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002679 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2680 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2681 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2682 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2683 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2684 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2685 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002686
2687tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2688 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002689 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002690 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2691 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2692 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2693 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2694 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2695 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2696 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002697
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002698tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2699tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2700 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2701 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2702 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002703 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002704 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002705 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2706 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2707 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2708 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002709 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002710
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002711tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002712 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002713 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2714 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2715 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2716 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2717 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2718 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2719 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2720 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2721 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2722 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2723 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002724
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002725tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002726 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002727 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2728 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2729 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2730 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2731 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2732
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002733tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2734 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2735 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2736 performances. This is disabled by default.
2737
2738 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2739 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2740
2741 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2742
2743 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2744
2745 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2746
2747 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2748 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2749 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2750
2751 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2752 converted.
2753
2754 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2755 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2756 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2757 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2758 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2759 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2760 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002761 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2762 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002763
2764 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2765
2766 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2767 only need this line:
2768
2769 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2770
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002771tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2772 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002773 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002774 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2775 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2776 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2777 being used for too long.
2778
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002779tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2780 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2781 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2782 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2783 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2784 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2785 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2786 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2787 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2788 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2789 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002790 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002791 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002792
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002793tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2794 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2795 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2796 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2797 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002798 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002799 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2800 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002801 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2802 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002803
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002804tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2805 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2806 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2807 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2808 1000 entries.
2809
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002810tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2811 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2812 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2813 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2814
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002815tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002816tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002817tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2818tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2819tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002820 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2821 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2822 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2823 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2824 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2825 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2826 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2827 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002828
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002829 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2830 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2831 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2832 all available space is consumed.
2833 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2834 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2835 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002836
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002837tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2838 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002839 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002840 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002841 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002842 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2843
2844tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2845 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2846 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002847 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2848 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028503.3. Debugging
2851--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002852
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002853quiet
2854 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2855 line argument "-q".
2856
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002857zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002858 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002859 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2860 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2861 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2862 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2863 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2864
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002865
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028663.4. Userlists
2867--------------
2868It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2869http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2870it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2871
2872userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002873 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002874 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2875
2876group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002877 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002878 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2879 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2880
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002881user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2882 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002883 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2884 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002885 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2886 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2887 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2888 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002889
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002890 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2891 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2892 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2893 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2894 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2895 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2896 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002897 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002898 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002899
2900 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002901 userlist L1
2902 group G1 users tiger,scott
2903 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002904
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002905 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2906 user scott insecure-password elgato
2907 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002908
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002909 userlist L2
2910 group G1
2911 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002912
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002913 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2914 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2915 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002916
2917 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002918
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002919
29203.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002921----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002922It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002923several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002924instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2925values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2926automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2927In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2928using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2929tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2930reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2931Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2932that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2933each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002934
2935peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002936 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002937 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2938
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002939bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2940 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2941 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2942
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002943disabled
2944 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2945 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2946 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2947
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002948default-bind [param*]
2949 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2950
2951default-server [param*]
2952 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2953
2954 Arguments:
2955 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2956 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2957 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2958 details.
2959
2960
2961 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2962
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002963enable
2964 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2965
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002966log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002967 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2968 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2969 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2970 more details.
2971
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002972peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002973 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2974 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002975 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002976 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002977 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2978 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2979 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002980
2981 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2982 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2983
2984 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002985 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2986 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2987 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002988
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002989 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2990 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002991
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002992 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2993 "server" keyword explanation below).
2994
2995server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002996 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002997 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2998 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2999 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
3000 of this "peers" section).
3001 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3002
3003
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003004 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003005 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003006 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003007 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3008 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3009 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003010
3011 backend mybackend
3012 mode tcp
3013 balance roundrobin
3014 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3015 stick on src
3016
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003017 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3018 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003019
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003020 Example:
3021 peers mypeers
3022 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3023 default-server ssl verify none
3024 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3025 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003026
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003027
3028table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3029 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3030
3031 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3032 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003033 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003034 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3035 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3036 "stick-table" keyword).
3037
3038 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3039 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3040 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3041 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3042 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3043 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3044 of the stick-table name as follows:
3045
3046 peers mypeers
3047 peer A ...
3048 peer B ...
3049 table t1 ...
3050
3051 frontend fe1
3052 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3053
3054 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3055 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3056
3057 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3058 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3059 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3060 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3061 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3062 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3063 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3064
3065 peers mypeers
3066 peer A ...
3067 peer B ...
3068 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3069
3070 backend t1
3071 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3072
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003073 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003074 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3075 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3076
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030773.6. Mailers
3078------------
3079It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3080If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3081in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3082
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003083mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003084 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3085 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3086
3087mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3088 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3089
3090 Example:
3091 mailers mymailers
3092 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3093 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3094
3095 backend mybackend
3096 mode tcp
3097 balance roundrobin
3098
3099 email-alert mailers mymailers
3100 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3101 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3102
3103 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3104 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3105
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003106timeout mail <time>
3107 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3108 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3109 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3110 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3111
3112 Example:
3113 mailers mymailers
3114 timeout mail 20s
3115 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003116
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031173.7. Programs
3118-------------
3119In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3120master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3121managed the same way as the workers.
3122
3123During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3124sequence as a worker:
3125
3126 - the master is re-executed
3127 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3128 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3129 instance of the program
3130
3131During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3132
3133program <name>
3134 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3135 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3136 the management guide).
3137
3138command <command> [arguments*]
3139 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3140 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3141 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3142 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3143
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003144user <user name>
3145 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3146 See also "group".
3147
3148group <group name>
3149 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3150 See also "user".
3151
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003152option start-on-reload
3153no option start-on-reload
3154 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3155 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3156 program section.
3157
3158
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031593.8. HTTP-errors
3160----------------
3161
3162It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3163imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3164several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3165
3166http-errors <name>
3167 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3168 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3169
3170errorfile <code> <file>
3171 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3172
3173 Arguments :
3174 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003175 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003176 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003177
3178 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3179 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3180 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3181 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3182 before any chroot is performed.
3183
3184 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3185
3186 Example:
3187 http-errors website-1
3188 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3189 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3190 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3191
3192 http-errors website-2
3193 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3194 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3195 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3196
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031973.9. Rings
3198----------
3199
3200It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3201servers or traces.
3202
3203ring <ringname>
3204 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3205
3206description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003207 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003208 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3209
3210format <format>
3211 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3212
3213 Arguments:
3214 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3215 one of the following :
3216
3217 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3218 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3219 designed to be used with a local log server.
3220
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003221 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3222 field is stripped. This is the default.
3223 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3224 rfc3164.
3225
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003226 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3227 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3228 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3229 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3230 is the default.
3231
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003232 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003233 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3234
3235 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3236 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3237
3238 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3239 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3240 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3241 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3242 logger consumes.
3243
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003244 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3245 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3246 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3247 with a local log server.
3248
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003249 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3250 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3251 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3252 used with a local log server.
3253
3254maxlen <length>
3255 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3256 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3257 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3258
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003259server <name> <address> [param*]
3260 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3261 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3262 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3263 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3264 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3265 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3266 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3267 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3268 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003269 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3270 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003271
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003272size <size>
3273 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3274 set to BUFSIZE.
3275
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003276timeout connect <timeout>
3277 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3278
3279 Arguments :
3280 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3281 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3282 as explained at the top of this document.
3283
3284timeout server <timeout>
3285 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3286
3287 Arguments :
3288 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3289 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3290 as explained at the top of this document.
3291
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003292 Example:
3293 global
3294 log ring@myring local7
3295
3296 ring myring
3297 description "My local buffer"
3298 format rfc3164
3299 maxlen 1200
3300 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003301 timeout connect 5s
3302 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003303 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003304
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033053.10. Log forwarding
3306-------------------
3307
3308It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003309HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003310
3311log-forward <name>
3312 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3313
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003314backlog <conns>
3315 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3316 on connections accept.
3317
3318bind <addr> [param*]
3319 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003320 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3321 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3322 syslog protocol over TCP.
3323 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003324 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3325
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003326dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003327 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3328 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3329 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3330 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003331 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003332
3333log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003334log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003335 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3336 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3337 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003338 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003339 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3340 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3341 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003342 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003343
3344 Example:
3345 global
3346 log stderr format iso local7
3347
3348 ring myring
3349 description "My local buffer"
3350 format rfc5424
3351 maxlen 1200
3352 size 32764
3353 timeout connect 5s
3354 timeout server 10s
3355 # syslog tcp server
3356 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3357
3358 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003359 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3360 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003361 # all messages on stderr
3362 log global
3363 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3364 log ring@myring local0
3365 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3366 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3367 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3368 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3369 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003370
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003371maxconn <conns>
3372 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3373 10 is the default.
3374
3375timeout client <timeout>
3376 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033784. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003379----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003380
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003381Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003382 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3383 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3384 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3385 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003386
3387A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3388connections.
3389
3390A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3391to forward incoming connections.
3392
3393A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3394parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3395
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003396A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3397ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3398sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3399the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3400explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3401from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3402"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3403for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3404to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3405optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3406are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3407any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3408names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3409that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3410duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3411names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3412
3413Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3414settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3415of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3416profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3417timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3418
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3420'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3421case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3422
3423Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3424logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3425proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3426However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3427name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3428
3429Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3430and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003431bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003432protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3433modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3434arbitrary criteria.
3435
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003436In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3437a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003438the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003439
3440 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3441 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3442 between responses and new requests.
3443
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003444 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3445 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3446 client-facing connection remains open.
3447
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003448 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3449 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003450
3451The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3452frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3453following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003454weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003455
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003456 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003457
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003458 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3459 ----+-----+-----+----
3460 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3461 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003462 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3463 ----+-----+-----+----
3464 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003465
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003466It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003467only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3468within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003469as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003470content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003471and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3472possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003473
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003474There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003475first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003476processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003477second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003478protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3479is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3480new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003481to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003482process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3483already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3484HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3485evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3486one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3487
3488There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3489performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3490tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3491preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3492analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3493HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3494header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3495mitigate this drawback.
3496
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003497There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003498method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3499set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3500in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3501is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3502to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3503above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3504to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3505"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3506frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3507frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3508as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3509upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3510on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3511the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3512upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3513frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3514remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035164.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3517--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003518
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003519The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3520limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3521they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3522limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003523marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003524option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003525and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3526with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3527specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003529
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003530 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3531------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3532acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003533backlog X X X -
3534balance X - X X
3535bind - X X -
3536bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003537capture cookie - X X -
3538capture request header - X X -
3539capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003540clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3541clitcpka-idle X X X -
3542clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003543compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003544cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003545declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003546default-server X - X X
3547default_backend X X X -
3548description - X X X
3549disabled X X X X
3550dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003551email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003552email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003553email-alert mailers X X X X
3554email-alert myhostname X X X X
3555email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003556enabled X X X X
3557errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003558errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003559errorloc X X X X
3560errorloc302 X X X X
3561-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3562errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003563force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003564filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003565fullconn X - X X
3566grace X X X X
3567hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003568http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003569http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003570http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003571http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003572http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003573http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003574http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003575http-check set-var X - X X
3576http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003577http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003578http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003579http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003580http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003581http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003582id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003583ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003584load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003585log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003586log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003587log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003588log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003589max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003590maxconn X X X -
3591mode X X X X
3592monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003593monitor-uri X X X -
3594option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3595option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3596option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3597option allbackups (*) X - X X
3598option checkcache (*) X - X X
3599option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3600option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003601option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003602option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3603option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003604-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3605option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003606option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3607option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003608option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003609option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003610option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003611option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003612option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003613option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3614option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3615option httpchk X - X X
3616option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003617option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003618option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003619option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003620option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003621option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003622option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3623option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3624option logasap (*) X X X -
3625option mysql-check X - X X
3626option nolinger (*) X X X X
3627option originalto X X X X
3628option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003629option pgsql-check X - X X
3630option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003631option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003632option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003633option smtpchk X - X X
3634option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3635option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3636option splice-request (*) X X X X
3637option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003638option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003639option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3640option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3641-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003642option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003643option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3644option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3645option tcpka X X X X
3646option tcplog X X X X
3647option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003648external-check command X - X X
3649external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003650persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3651rate-limit sessions X X X -
3652redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003653-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003655retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003656server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003657server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003658server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003659source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003660srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3661srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3662srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003663stats admin - X X X
3664stats auth X X X X
3665stats enable X X X X
3666stats hide-version X X X X
3667stats http-request - X X X
3668stats realm X X X X
3669stats refresh X X X X
3670stats scope X X X X
3671stats show-desc X X X X
3672stats show-legends X X X X
3673stats show-node X X X X
3674stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003675-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3676stick match - - X X
3677stick on - - X X
3678stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003679stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003680stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003681tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003682tcp-check connect X - X X
3683tcp-check expect X - X X
3684tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003685tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003686tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003687tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003688tcp-check set-var X - X X
3689tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003690tcp-request connection - X X -
3691tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003692tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003693tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003694tcp-response content - - X X
3695tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003696timeout check X - X X
3697timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003698timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003699timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003700timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3701timeout http-request X X X X
3702timeout queue X - X X
3703timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003704timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003705timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003706timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003707transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003708unique-id-format X X X -
3709unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003710use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003711use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003712use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003713------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3714 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003715
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037174.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3718---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003719
3720This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3721
3722
3723acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3724 Declare or complete an access list.
3725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3726 no | yes | yes | yes
3727 Example:
3728 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3729 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3730 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3731
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003732 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003733
3734
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003735backlog <conns>
3736 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3738 yes | yes | yes | no
3739 Arguments :
3740 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3741 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003742 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003743
3744 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3745 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3746 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3747 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3748 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3749 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3750 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3751 backlog parameter.
3752
3753 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3754 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3755 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3756
3757 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3758
3759
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003760balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003761balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003762 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3764 yes | no | yes | yes
3765 Arguments :
3766 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3767 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3768 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3769 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3770
3771 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3772 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3773 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3774 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003775 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003776 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003777 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3778 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3779 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3780 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3781 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3782 it, so that you don't worry.
3783
3784 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3785 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3786 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3787 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3788 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3789 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3790 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3791 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003792
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003793 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3794 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3795 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3796 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3797 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3798 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3799 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003800 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3801 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3802 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003803
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003804 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003805 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003806 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3807 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003808 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003809 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3810 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3811 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3812 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3813 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003814 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3815 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3816 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3817 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3818 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3819 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003820
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003821 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3822 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3823 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3824 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3825 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3826 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3827 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3828 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003829 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003830 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003831 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3832 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3833 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003834
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003835 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3836 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3837 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3838 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3839 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3840 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3841 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3842 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3843 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3844 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3845 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3846 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003847
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003848 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003849 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3850 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3851 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3852 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3853 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3854 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3855 URIs start with a leading "/".
3856
3857 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3858 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3859 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3860 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3861
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003862 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3863 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3864 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3865 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3866
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003867 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003868 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3869
3870 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003871 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3872 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003873 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3874 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3875 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3876 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003877 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003878 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3879 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003880
3881 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3882 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3883 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3884 server will receive the request.
3885
3886 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3887 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3888 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3889 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3890 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003891 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3892 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3893 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003894
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003895 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3896 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3897 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3898 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3899 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003901 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003902 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3903 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3904 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3905
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003906 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3907 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3908 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3909
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003910 random
3911 random(<draws>)
3912 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003913 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3914 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3915 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3916 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003917 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3918 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3919 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3920 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3921 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3922 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3923 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3924 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3925 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3926 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3927 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3928 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3929 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3930 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3931 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3932 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3933 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3934 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3935 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3936 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003937
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003938 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003939 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003940 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3941 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3942 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3943 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3944 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3945 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003946 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003947 used instead.
3948
3949 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3950 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3951 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3952 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3953
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003954 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3955 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3956 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3957
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003958 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003959
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003960 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003961 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3962 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003963
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003964 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3965 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3966 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003967
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003968 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003969 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003970 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3971 NTLM relies on.
3972
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003973 Examples :
3974 balance roundrobin
3975 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003976 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003977 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3978 balance hdr(host)
3979 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003980
3981 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3982 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003984 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003985 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3986 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3987 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003988 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003989
3990 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3991 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3992 defaults to 16 kB.
3993
3994 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3995 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3996
3997 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3998 Round Robin.
3999
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004000 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004001 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4002 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4003 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4004
4005 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4006
4007 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004008 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004009 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4010 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4011 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004012
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004013 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004014
4015
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004016bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4017bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004018 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4020 no | yes | yes | no
4021 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004022 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4023 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4024 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4025 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004026 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004027 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4028 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4029 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4030 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4031 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4032 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004033 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004034 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4035 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004036 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004037 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4038 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004039 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004040 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4041 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004042 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004043 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4044 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4045 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4046 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4047 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4048 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4049 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004050 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4051 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4052 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004053 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4054 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4055 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4056 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004057 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4058 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4059 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004060
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004061 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4062 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004063 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4064 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4065 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004066 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4067 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4068 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4069 the range.
4070
4071 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4072 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4073 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4074 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4075 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4076 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4077 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004078 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004079 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004080
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004081 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004082 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004083 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4084 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4085 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4086 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4087 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4088 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4089
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004090 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4091 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4092 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4093 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004095 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4096 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4097 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4098 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4099 in a frontend.
4100
4101 Example :
4102 listen http_proxy
4103 bind :80,:443
4104 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004105 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004106
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004107 listen http_https_proxy
4108 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004109 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004110
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004111 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4112 bind ipv6@:80
4113 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4114 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4115
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004116 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004117 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004118
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004119 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4120 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4121 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4122 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4123 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4124
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004125 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004126 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004127
4128
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004129bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004130 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4132 yes | yes | yes | yes
4133 Arguments :
4134 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4135 may be used to override a default value.
4136
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004137 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004138 option may be combined with other numbers.
4139
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004140 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004141 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4142 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4143 missing from all processes.
4144
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004145 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004146 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004147 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4148 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4149 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4150 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4151 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004152 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004153
4154 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4155 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4156 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4157 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4158 and 'even' instances.
4159
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004160 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4161 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4162 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4163 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004164
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004165 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4166 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4167
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004168 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4169 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4170 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4171
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004172 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4173 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4174
4175 Example :
4176 listen app_ip1
4177 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004178 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004179
4180 listen app_ip2
4181 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004182 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004183
4184 listen management
4185 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004186 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004187
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004188 listen management
4189 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4190 bind-process 1-4
4191
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004192 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004193
4194
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004195capture cookie <name> len <length>
4196 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4198 no | yes | yes | no
4199 Arguments :
4200 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4201 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4202 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4203 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004204 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004205
4206 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4207 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4208 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4209 right if it exceeds <length>.
4210
4211 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4212 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4213 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4214 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4215
4216 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4217 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4218 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4219
4220 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4221 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4222 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004223 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4224 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4225 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004226
4227 Example:
4228 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4229
4230 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004231 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004232
4233
4234capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004235 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4237 no | yes | yes | no
4238 Arguments :
4239 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004240 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004241 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4242 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4243 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4244
4245 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4246 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4247 it exceeds <length>.
4248
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004249 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004250 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4251 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004252 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4253 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4254 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4255 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004256 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004257 environments to find where the request came from.
4258
4259 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4260 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4261 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4262 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004263
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004264 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4265 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4266 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4267 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4268 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004269
4270 Example:
4271 capture request header Host len 15
4272 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004273 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004275 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004276 about logging.
4277
4278
4279capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004280 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4282 no | yes | yes | no
4283 Arguments :
4284 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004285 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004286 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4287 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4288 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4289
4290 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4291 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4292 it exceeds <length>.
4293
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004294 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004295 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4296 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4297 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004298 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4299 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4300 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4301 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004302
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004303 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4304 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4305 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4306 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4307 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004308
4309 Example:
4310 capture response header Content-length len 9
4311 capture response header Location len 15
4312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004313 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004314 about logging.
4315
4316
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004317clitcpka-cnt <count>
4318 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4319 the connection on the client side.
4320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4321 yes | yes | yes | no
4322 Arguments :
4323 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4324
4325 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4326 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004327 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4328 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004329
4330 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4331
4332
4333clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4334 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4335 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4336 client side.
4337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4338 yes | yes | yes | no
4339 Arguments :
4340 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4341 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4342 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4343 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4344
4345 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4346 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004347 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4348 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004349
4350 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4351
4352
4353clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4354 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4356 yes | yes | yes | no
4357 Arguments :
4358 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4359 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4360 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4361 document.
4362
4363 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4364 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004365 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4366 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004367
4368 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4369
4370
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004371compression algo <algorithm> ...
4372compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004373compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004374 Enable HTTP compression.
4375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4376 yes | yes | yes | yes
4377 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004378 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4379 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004380 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004381
4382 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004383 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4384 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4385 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004386
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004387 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004388 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004389
4390 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4391 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4392 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4393 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4394 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004395 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004396
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004397 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4398 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4399 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4400 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4401 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4402 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4403 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004404 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004405
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004406 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004407 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004408 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004409 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004410 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004411 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004412 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004413
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004414 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004415 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4416 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004417 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4418 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004419 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004420 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004421 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4422 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004423 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004424 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4425 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004426
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004427 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004428 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4429 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004430 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004431 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004432 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4433 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4434 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4435 "multipart"
4436 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4437 header
4438 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4439 and later
4440 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4441 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004442 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004443
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004444 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004445
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004446 Examples :
4447 compression algo gzip
4448 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004449
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004450
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004451cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004452 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4453 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004454 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004455 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4457 yes | no | yes | yes
4458 Arguments :
4459 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4460 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4461 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4462 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4463 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4464 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004465 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004466 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4467 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4468
4469 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004470 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004471 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4472 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4473 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4474 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004475 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4476 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004477 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004478 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4479 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004480
4481 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004482 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004483
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004484 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004485 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004486 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004487 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004488 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4489 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4490 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4491 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4492 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4493 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4494 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004495
4496 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4497 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4498 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4499 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4500 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4501 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4502 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4503 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4504 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004505 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004506 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4507 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4508 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004509
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004510 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4511 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4512 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004513 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4514 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4515 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4516 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004517 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4518 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4519 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004520
4521 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4522 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4523 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4524 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4525 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4526 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4527 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4528 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4529 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4530
4531 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4532 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4533 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4534 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4535 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4536 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4537 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4538 persistence cookie in the cache.
4539 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4540
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004541 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4542 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004543 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004544 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4545 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004546 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004547 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4548 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4549 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4550 they logout.
4551
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004552 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004553 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4554 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4555 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4556
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004557 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004558 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4559 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4560 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4561 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4562 this attribute.
4563
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004564 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004565 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004566 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4567 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4568 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4569 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4570 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4571 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004572
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004573 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4574 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4575 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4576 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4577 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4578 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4579 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4580 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004581 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004582 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4583 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4584 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4585 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4586 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4587 the site.
4588
4589 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4590 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4591 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4592 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4593 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4594 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4595 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4596 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4597 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4598 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4599 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4600 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4601 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004602 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004603 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4604 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4605
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004606 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4607 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4608 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4609 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4610 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4611 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4612
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004613 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004614 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4615 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4616 repeated.
4617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004618 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4619 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4620 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4621 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004622
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004623 Examples :
4624 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4625 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4626 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004627 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004628
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004629 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004630
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004631
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004632declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4633 Declares a capture slot.
4634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4635 no | yes | yes | no
4636 Arguments:
4637 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4638
4639 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4640 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4641 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4642 for use in the response.
4643
4644 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004645 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004646 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4647
4648
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004649default-server [param*]
4650 Change default options for a server in a backend
4651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4652 yes | no | yes | yes
4653 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004654 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4655 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4656 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4657 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004658
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004659 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004660 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4661
4662 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004663
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004664
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004665default_backend <backend>
4666 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4668 yes | yes | yes | no
4669 Arguments :
4670 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4671
4672 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4673 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4674 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4675 will catch all undetermined requests.
4676
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004677 Example :
4678
4679 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4680 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4681 default_backend dynamic
4682
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004683 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004685
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004686description <string>
4687 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4689 no | yes | yes | yes
4690 Arguments : string
4691
4692 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4693 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4694 it describes.
4695 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4696
4697
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004698disabled
4699 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4701 yes | yes | yes | yes
4702 Arguments : none
4703
4704 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4705 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4706 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4707 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4708 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4709 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4710 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4711
4712 See also : "enabled"
4713
4714
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004715dispatch <address>:<port>
4716 Set a default server address
4717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4718 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004719 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004720
4721 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4722 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4723 during start-up.
4724
4725 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4726 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4727 possible with normal servers.
4728
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004729 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004730 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4731 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4732 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4733 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4734
4735 See also : "server"
4736
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004737
4738dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4739 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4741 yes | no | yes | yes
4742 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4743
4744 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004745 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004746 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4747 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004748 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004749 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004750
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004751enabled
4752 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4754 yes | yes | yes | yes
4755 Arguments : none
4756
4757 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4758 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4759
4760 See also : "disabled"
4761
4762
4763errorfile <code> <file>
4764 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4766 yes | yes | yes | yes
4767 Arguments :
4768 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004769 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004770 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004771
4772 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004773 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004774 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004775 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4776 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004777
4778 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4779 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4780 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4781
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004782 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4783
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004784 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4785 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4786 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4787 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4788 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4789 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4790 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4791 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4792 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004793
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004794 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4795 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4796 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004797 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004798 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4799
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004800 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004801
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004802 Example :
4803 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004804 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004805 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4806 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4807
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004808
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004809errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4810 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4811 section.
4812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4813 yes | yes | yes | yes
4814 Arguments :
4815 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4816
4817 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004818 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004819 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4820 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004821
4822 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4823 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4824 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4825 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4826 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004827 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004828 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4829
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004830 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4831 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004832
4833 Example :
4834 errorfiles generic
4835 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4836
4837
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004838errorloc <code> <url>
4839errorloc302 <code> <url>
4840 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4842 yes | yes | yes | yes
4843 Arguments :
4844 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004845 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004846 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004847
4848 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4849 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4850 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4851 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004852 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004853
4854 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4855 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4856 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4857
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004858 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4859
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004860 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4861 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4862 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4863 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004864 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004865 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4866 request.
4867
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004868 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004869
4870
4871errorloc303 <code> <url>
4872 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4874 yes | yes | yes | yes
4875 Arguments :
4876 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004877 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004878 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004879
4880 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4881 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4882 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4883 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004884 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004885
4886 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4887 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4888 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4889
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004890 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4891
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004892 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4893 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4894 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4895 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004896 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004897
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004898 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004899
4900
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004901email-alert from <emailaddr>
4902 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004903 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004904 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4905 yes | yes | yes | yes
4906
4907 Arguments :
4908
4909 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4910
4911 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4912 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4913
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004914 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004915 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4916 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004917
4918
4919email-alert level <level>
4920 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4921 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4922 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4923 yes | yes | yes | yes
4924
4925 Arguments :
4926
4927 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4928 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4929 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4930
4931 By default level is alert
4932
4933 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4934 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4935 for the proxy.
4936
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004937 Alerts are sent when :
4938
4939 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4940 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4941 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4942 is notice or lower
4943 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4944 and a health check status update occurs
4945
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004946 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4947 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004948 section 3.6 about mailers.
4949
4950
4951email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4952 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4953 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4954 yes | yes | yes | yes
4955
4956 Arguments :
4957
4958 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4959
4960 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4961 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4962
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004963 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4964 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004965
4966
4967email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4968 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4969 mailers.
4970 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4971 yes | yes | yes | yes
4972
4973 Arguments :
4974
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004975 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004976
4977 By default the systems hostname is used.
4978
4979 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4980 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4981 for the proxy.
4982
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004983 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4984 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004985
4986
4987email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004988 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004989 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4990 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4991 yes | yes | yes | yes
4992
4993 Arguments :
4994
4995 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4996
4997 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4998 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4999
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005000 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005001 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5002
5003
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005004force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5005 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5006 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005007 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005008
5009 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5010 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5011 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5012 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5013 marked down for maintenance operations.
5014
5015 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5016 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5017 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5018 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5019 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5020 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5021 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5022 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5023 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5024
5025 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5026 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5027 is used.
5028
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005029 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005030 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005031
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005032
5033filter <name> [param*]
5034 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5036 no | yes | yes | yes
5037 Arguments :
5038 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5039 referenced in section 9.
5040
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005041 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005042 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005043 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5044 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005045
5046 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5047 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5048
5049 Example:
5050 listen
5051 bind *:80
5052
5053 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5054 filter compression
5055 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5056
5057 compression algo gzip
5058 compression offload
5059
5060 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5061
5062 See also : section 9.
5063
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005064
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005065fullconn <conns>
5066 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5068 yes | no | yes | yes
5069 Arguments :
5070 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5071 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5072
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005073 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005074 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005075 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005076 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5077 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5078 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5079 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5080 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005081 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005082
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005083 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005084 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005085 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5086 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5087 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005088
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005089 Example :
5090 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5091 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5092 # connections.
5093 backend dynamic
5094 fullconn 10000
5095 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5096 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5097
5098 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5099
5100
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005101grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005102 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005104 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005105 Arguments :
5106 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5107 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5108 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5109
5110 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5111 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005112 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005113 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5114
5115 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5116 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5117 simplify it.
5118
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005119
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005120hash-balance-factor <factor>
5121 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5123 yes | no | no | yes
5124 Arguments :
5125 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5126 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005127 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005128
5129 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5130 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5131 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5132 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5133 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5134 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5135 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5136
5137 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5138 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5139 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5140 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5141 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5142
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005143 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5144 consistent hashing mechanism.
5145
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005146 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5147
5148
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005149hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005150 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5152 yes | no | yes | yes
5153 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005154 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5155 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005156
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005157 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5158 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5159 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5160 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5161 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5162 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5163 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5164 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5165 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5166 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005167
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005168 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5169 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5170 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5171 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5172 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5173 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5174 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5175 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5176 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5177 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5178 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5179 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5180 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005181 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5182 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005183
5184 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5185
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005186 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005187 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5188 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5189 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005190 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5191 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5192 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005193
5194 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5195 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005196 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5197 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5198 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5199 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5200
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005201 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005202 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5203 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5204 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5205 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5206 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5207 parameter.
5208
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005209 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5210 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5211 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5212 used on strings.
5213
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005214 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5215
5216 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5217 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5218 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5219 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5220 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5221 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5222 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5223 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5224 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5225 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5226 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5227 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005228
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005229 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5230 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5231 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005232
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005233 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005234
5235
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005236http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5237 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5238 ones).
5239
5240 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5241 no | yes | yes | yes
5242
5243 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5244 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5245 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5246 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5247 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5248 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5249
5250 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5251 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5252 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5253
5254 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5255 below.
5256
5257 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5258 instance.
5259
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005260 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5261 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5262 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5263
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005264 Example:
5265 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5266 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5267 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5268
5269http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5270
5271 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5272 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5273 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5274 example, or to pass some internal information.
5275 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5276 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5277 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5278
5279http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5280
5281 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5282 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5283
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005284http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005285
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005286 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5287 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5288 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5289 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5290 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005291
5292http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5293 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5294
5295 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5296
5297 Example:
5298 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5299
5300 # applied to:
5301 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5302
5303 # outputs:
5304 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5305
5306 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5307
5308http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5309 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5310
5311 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5312
5313 Example:
5314 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5315
5316 # applied to:
5317 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5318
5319 # outputs:
5320 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5321
5322http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5323
5324 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5325 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5326 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5327
5328http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5329 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5330
5331 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5332 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5333 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5334 fallback.
5335
5336 Example:
5337 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5338 http-response set-status 431
5339 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5340 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5341
5342http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5343
5344 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5345 inline.
5346
5347 Arguments:
5348 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5349 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5350 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5351 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5352 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5353 (request and response)
5354 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5355 processing
5356 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5357 processing
5358 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5359 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5360 and '_'.
5361
5362 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5363 followed by some converters.
5364
5365 Example:
5366 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5367
5368http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5369
5370 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5371 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5372 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5373 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5374 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005375 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005376 processing.
5377
5378 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5379 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005380 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005381 rules evaluation.
5382
5383http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5384
5385 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5386 details about <var-name>.
5387
5388 Example:
5389 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5390
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005391
5392http-check comment <string>
5393 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5394 it fails.
5395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5396 yes | no | yes | yes
5397
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005398 Arguments :
5399 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5400 rule fails.
5401
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005402 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5403 user-friendly error reporting.
5404
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005405 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005406 "http-check expect".
5407
5408
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005409http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5410 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005411 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005412 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5414 yes | no | yes | yes
5415
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005416 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005417 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5418
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005419 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005420 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005421
5422 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5423 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5424 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5425 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5426
5427 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5428
5429 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5430
5431 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5432
5433 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5434
5435 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5436
5437 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5438 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5439 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5440 is used.
5441
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005442 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5443 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5444 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5445 haproxy -vv.
5446
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005447 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5448
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005449 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5450 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5451 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5452 different ports or with different servers.
5453
5454 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5455 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5456 the port with a "http-check connect".
5457
5458 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5459 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5460 do.
5461
5462 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5463 unset-var or comment rules.
5464
5465 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005466 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5467 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5468 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5469 option httpchk
5470
5471 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005472 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005473 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005474 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005475 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005476 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005477
5478 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5479
5480 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005481
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005482
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005483http-check disable-on-404
5484 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005486 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005487 Arguments : none
5488
5489 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5490 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5491 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5492 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5493 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5494 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5495 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5496 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005497 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5498 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005499 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5500 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5501 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005502
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005503 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005504
5505
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005506http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005507 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5508 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5509 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005510 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005512 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005513
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005514 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005515 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5516
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005517 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5518 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5519 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5520 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5521 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5522 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5523 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5524 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5525 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5526 result is always conclusive.
5527
5528 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5529 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5530 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005531 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5532 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005533 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5534 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005535 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5536 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5537 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005538
5539 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5540 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005541 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5542 supported :
5543 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5544 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005545 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5546 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5547 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5548 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5549 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005550
5551 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5552 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005553 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5554 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5555 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5556 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005557 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5558
5559 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5560 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5561 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5562 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5563
5564 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5565 informational message reported in logs if an error
5566 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5567 log-format string.
5568
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005569 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005570 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5571 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005572 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5573 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5574 details on the supported keywords.
5575
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005576 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5577 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5578 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5579 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005580
5581 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5582 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5583 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5584 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5585 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5586
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005587 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5588 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5589 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5590 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5591 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5592 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5593 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005594
5595 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005596 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005597 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5598 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5599 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5600 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5601
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005602 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5603 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005604 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5605 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5606 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5607 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5608 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5609 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5610 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5611 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005612 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5613 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5614 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5615 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5616 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5617 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5618 insensitive on the header names.
5619
5620 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5621 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5622 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5623 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5624 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5625 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005626
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005627 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005628 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005629 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5630 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5631 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5632 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5633 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005634 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005635 trace).
5636
5637 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005638 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005639 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5640 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5641 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5642 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5643 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005644 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005645
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005646 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5647 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5648 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5649 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5650 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5651 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5652
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005653 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005654 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005655 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5656 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5657 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5658 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5659 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5660 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5661
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005662 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5663 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5664 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5665 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5666 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005667
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005668 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5669 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5670
5671 Examples :
5672 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005673 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005674
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005675 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5676 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5677
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005678 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005679 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005680
5681 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005682 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005683
5684 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005685 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005686
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005687 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005688 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005689
5690
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005691http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005692 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5693 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005694 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5695 health checks.
5696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5697 yes | no | yes | yes
5698 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005699 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5700
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005701 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5702 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5703 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5704 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5705 to invent non-standard ones.
5706
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005707 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5708 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5709 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5710 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5711
5712 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5713 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5714 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5715 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005716
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005717 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005718 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005719 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005720 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5721 to add it.
5722
5723 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5724 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5725 to the log-format rules.
5726
5727 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5728 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5729 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005730
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005731 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5732 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5733 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5734 request.
5735
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005736 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5737 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5738 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005739 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5740 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5741 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5742 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005743 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005744
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005745 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005746 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5747 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005748
5749 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5750 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5751 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5752 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5753 configured request authority.
5754
5755 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5756 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005757
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005758 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005759
5760
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005761http-check send-state
5762 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5764 yes | no | yes | yes
5765 Arguments : none
5766
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005767 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005768 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005769 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5770 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5771 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005772
5773 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5774 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5775 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5776 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5777 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005778 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5779 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5780 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5781
5782 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5783 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5784 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5785
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005786 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5787 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5788 checked in multiple backends.
5789
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005790 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005791 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5792
5793 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5794 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5795 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5796 one fails.
5797
5798 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5799 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5800 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5801
5802 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5803 server's queue.
5804
5805 Example of a header received by the application server :
5806 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5807 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5808
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005809 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5810 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005811
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005812
5813http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005814 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005815 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5816 yes | no | yes | yes
5817
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005818 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005819 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5820 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5821 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5822 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5823 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5824 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5825 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5826 and '-'.
5827
5828 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5829
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005830 Examples :
5831 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005832
5833
5834http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005835 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005836 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5837 yes | no | yes | yes
5838
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005839 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005840 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5841 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5842 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5843 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5844 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5845 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5846 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5847 and '-'.
5848
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005849 Examples :
5850 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005851
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005852
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005853http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5854 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5855 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5856 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5857 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5859 yes | yes | yes | yes
5860 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005861 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005862 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005863 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005864 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005865
5866 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5867 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5868 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5869 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5870
5871 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5872 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5873 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5874 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5875
5876 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5877 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5878 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5879 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5880 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5881 chroot is performed.
5882
5883 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5884 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5885 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5886 considered.
5887
5888 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5889 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5890 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5891 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5892 considered as a raw string.
5893
5894 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5895 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5896 "content-type".
5897
5898 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5899 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5900 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5901 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5902 evaluated as a log-format string.
5903
5904 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5905 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5906 argument to "content-type".
5907
5908 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5909 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5910 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5911 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5912
5913 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5914 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5915 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5916 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5917 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5918 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5919 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5920 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5921
5922 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5923 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5924 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5925
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005926 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5927 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5928 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5929 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5930 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5931
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005932 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5933 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5934
5935
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005936http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005937 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5938
5939 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5940 no | yes | yes | yes
5941
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005942 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5943 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5944 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5945 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5946 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005947
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005948 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5949 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005950
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005951 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005952
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005953 Example:
5954 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5955 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5956 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005957
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005958 http-request allow if nagios
5959 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5960 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5961 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005962
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005963 Example:
5964 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5965 acl add path /addacl
5966 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005967
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005968 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005969
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005970 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5971 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005972
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005973 Example:
5974 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5975 acl setmap path /setmap
5976 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005977
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005978 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005979
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005980 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5981 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005983 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5984 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005985
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005986http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005987
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005988 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5989 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5990 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5991 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5992 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5993 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5994 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5995 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005996
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005997http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005998
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005999 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6000 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6001 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6002 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6003 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6004 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6005 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6006 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006008http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006009
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006010 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6011 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006012
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006014http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006016 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6017 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6018 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6019 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6020 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006021
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006022 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6023 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6024 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6025 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6026 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6027 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6028 instead.
6029
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006030 Example:
6031 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6032 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006033
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006034http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006035
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006036 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006037
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006038http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6039 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006040
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006041 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6042 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6043 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6044 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6045 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6046 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6047 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6048 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6049 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006051 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6052 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6053 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006054 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6055
6056 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6057 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6058 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6059 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006060
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006061http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006062
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006063 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6064 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6065 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6066 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6067 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6068 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006069
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006070http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006071
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006072 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6073 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6074 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6075 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6076 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006077
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006078http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006079
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006080 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6081 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6082 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6083 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6084 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6085 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006086
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006087http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6088http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6089 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6090 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6091 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6092 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006093
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006094 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6095 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6096 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006097 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006098 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6099 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6100 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006101 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006102 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006103
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006104http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6105 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6106 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6107 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6108
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006109http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6110
6111 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6112 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6113 pointed by <resolvers>.
6114 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6115 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6116 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6117 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6118 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6119 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6120 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6121 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6122 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6123 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6124 to 0.0.0.0.
6125
6126 Example:
6127 resolvers mydns
6128 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6129 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6130 timeout retry 1s
6131 hold valid 10s
6132 hold nx 3s
6133 hold other 3s
6134 hold obsolete 0s
6135 accepted_payload_size 8192
6136
6137 frontend fe
6138 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6139 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6140 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6141
6142 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6143 # which mean DNS resolution error
6144 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6145
6146 default_backend be
6147
6148 backend b_503
6149 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6150 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6151 # 503 error page to end users
6152
6153 backend be
6154 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6155 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6156 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6157 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6158 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6159
6160 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6161 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6162
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006163http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6164
6165 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6166 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6167 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6168 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006169 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6170 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006171
6172 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6173
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006174http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006175http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006176http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006177http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006178http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006179http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006180http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006181http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6182http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006183
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006184 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6185
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006186 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006187 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6188 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6189 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6190 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006191
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006192 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6193 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6194 the supported backend.
6195
6196 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6197 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6198 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6199 number of segments in the path.
6200
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006201 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6202 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6203 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6204 when improperly combined.
6205
6206 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6207 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6208 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6209 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6210 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6211
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006212 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006213
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006214 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6215
6216 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6217 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6218
6219 Example:
6220 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6221
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006222 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6223
6224 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6225 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6226
6227 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6228 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6229
6230 Example:
6231 - /#foo -> /
6232
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006233 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6234 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006235
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006236 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6237 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6238
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006239 Example:
6240 - /. -> /
6241 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6242 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6243 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006244
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006245 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6246 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6247
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006248 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006249 their preceding segment.
6250
6251 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6252 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6253
6254 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6255 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006256
6257 Example:
6258 - /foo/../ -> /
6259 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6260 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6261 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006262 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006263 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006264 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006265
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006266 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6267 removed as well:
6268
6269 Example:
6270 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6271 - /bar/../../ -> /
6272
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006273 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6274 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006275
6276 Example:
6277 - // -> /
6278 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6279
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006280 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6281 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6282
6283 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6284 ".", "_", and "~".
6285
6286 Example:
6287 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6288 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6289 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6290 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6291
6292 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6293 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6294
6295 Example:
6296 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6297 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6298
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006299 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006300 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006301
6302 Example:
6303 - /%6f -> /%6F
6304 - /%zz -> /%zz
6305
6306 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6307 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6308
6309 Example:
6310 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6311
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006312 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006313 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6314 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6315
6316 Example:
6317 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6318 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6319 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006321http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006323 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6324 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6325 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6326 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6327 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006329http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006331 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6332 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6333 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6334 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006336http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6337 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006338
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006339 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006340 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6341 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6342 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6343 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6344 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006345
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006346 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6347 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6348 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6349 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6350 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006351
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006352 Example:
6353 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6354
6355 # applied to:
6356 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6357
6358 # outputs:
6359 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6360
6361 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006362
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006363 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6364
6365 # applied to:
6366 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006367
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006368 # outputs:
6369 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006370
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006371http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6372 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6373
6374 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6375 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006376 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6377 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6378 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006379
6380 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6381 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6382 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6383
6384 Example:
6385 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6386 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6387
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006388 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6389 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6390 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6391 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6392
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006393http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6394 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6395
6396 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6397 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6398 query-string are replaced.
6399
6400 Example:
6401 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6402 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6403
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006404http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6405 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6406
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006407 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6408 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6409 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6410 against.
6411
6412 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6413 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6414 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006415
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006416 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6417 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6418 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6419 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6420 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6421 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6422 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6423 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6424 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006425 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6426 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006427
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006428 Example:
6429 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6430 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006431
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006432 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6433 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006434
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006435http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6436 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006437
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006438 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6439 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6440 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6441 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006442
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006443 Example:
6444 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006445
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006446 # applied to:
6447 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006448
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006449 # outputs:
6450 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006451
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006452http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6453 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6454 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006455 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006456 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6457
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006458 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006459 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6460 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006461 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006462 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006463 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006464 are followed to create the response :
6465
6466 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6467 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6468 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6469 ignored.
6470
6471 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6472 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006473 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006474 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6475 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006476
6477 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6478 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6479 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006480 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006481 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006482
6483 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6484 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6485 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006486 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006487 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006488 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006489
6490 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6491 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6492 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6493 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6494 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6495 as a raw content.
6496
6497 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6498 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6499 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6500 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6501 considered as a raw string.
6502
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006503 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006504 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6505 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6506 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6507
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006508 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6509 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006510 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006511
6512 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6513
6514 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006515 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006516 if { path /ping }
6517
6518 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6519 if { path /favicon.ico }
6520
6521 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6522 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6523 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006525http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6526http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006527
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006528 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6529 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6530 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006531
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006532http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6533 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006534
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006535 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6536 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6537 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6538 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006539
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006540http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006542 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6543 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6544 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6545 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6546 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006547
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006548 Arguments:
6549 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6550 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006551
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006552 Example:
6553 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6554 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006556 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6557 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006558
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006559http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006561 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6562 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6563 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006564
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006565 Arguments:
6566 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6567 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006569 Example:
6570 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6571 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006573 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6574 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6575 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006577http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006579 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6580 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6581 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6582 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6583 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006584
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006585 Example:
6586 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6587 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6588 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6589 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6590 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6591 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6592 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6593 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6594 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006596http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006598 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6599 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6600 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6601 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6602 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006604http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6605 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006607 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6608 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6609 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6610 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6611 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6612 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6613 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6614 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6615 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006617http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006619 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6620 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6621 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6622 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6623 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6624 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6625 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006627http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006629 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6630 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6631 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006633http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006635 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6636 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6637 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6638 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6639 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6640 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6641 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6642 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006644http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006646 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6647 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6648 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6649 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6650 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6651 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006652
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006653 Example :
6654 # prepend the host name before the path
6655 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006656
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006657http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6658
6659 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6660 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6661 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006663http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006665 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6666 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6667 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6668 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6669 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006671http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006673 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6674 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6675 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6676 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6677 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6678 values have higher priority.
6679 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6680 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6681 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6682 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6683 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006684
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006685http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006686
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006687 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6688 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6689 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6690 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6691 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6692 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6693 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006694
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006695 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006696
6697 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006698 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6699 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006700
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006701http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6702 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6703 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6704 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006705 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6706 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006707
6708 Arguments :
6709 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6710 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006711
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006712 See also "option forwardfor".
6713
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006714 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006715 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6716 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6717
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006718 # After the masking this will track connections
6719 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6720 http-request track-sc0 src
6721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006722 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6723 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6724
6725http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6726
6727 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6728 expression.
6729
6730 Arguments:
6731 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6732 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006733
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006734 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006735 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6736 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6737
6738 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6739 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6740 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6741
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006742http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006743 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6744
6745 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6746 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6747 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6748 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6749 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6750
6751 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6752 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6753 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6754 results.
6755
6756 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006757 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6758 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006759
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006760http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6761
6762 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6763 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6764 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6765 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6766 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6767 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6768 information from the request.
6769
6770 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6771
6772http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6773
6774 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6775 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6776 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6777 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6778 path and the query string.
6779 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6780
6781http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6782
6783 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6784 inline.
6785
6786 Arguments:
6787 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6788 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6789 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6790 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6791 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6792 (request and response)
6793 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6794 processing
6795 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6796 processing
6797 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6798 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6799 and '_'.
6800
6801 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6802 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006803
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006804 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006805 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006807http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6808 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006809
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006810 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6811 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6812 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6813 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6814 agent name must be used.
6815
6816 Arguments:
6817 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6818
6819 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6820 configuration.
6821
6822http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6823
6824 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6825 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6826 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6827 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6828 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6829 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6830 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6831 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6832 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6833 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6834 action.
6835 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6836 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6837 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6838 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6839 you fully understand how it works.
6840
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006841http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6842
6843 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6844 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6845 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6846 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6847 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006848 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006849 processing.
6850
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006851 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006852 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6853 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6854 rules evaluation.
6855
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006856http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6857http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6858 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6859 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6860 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6861 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006862
6863 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6864 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6865 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006866 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6867 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6868 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6869 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6870 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6871 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006872 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006873 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6874 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6875 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006876 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006877 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6878 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6879 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6880 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6881 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006882
6883http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6884http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6885http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6886
6887 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6888 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6889 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6890 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006891 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006892 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6893 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6894 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6895 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6896 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6897 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6898 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6899
6900 Arguments :
6901 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6902 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6903 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6904 select which table entry to update the counters.
6905
6906 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6907 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6908 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6909 that table until the session ends.
6910
6911 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6912 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6913 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6914 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6915 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6916 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6917 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6918 useful information.
6919
6920 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6921 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6922 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6923 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6924 checks that make use of it.
6925
6926http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6927
6928 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006929
6930 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006931 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006932
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006933http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6934
6935 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6936 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6937 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6938 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6939 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6940 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6941
6942 Arguments :
6943 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6944
6945 Example:
6946 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6947
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006948http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6949 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6950
6951 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6952 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6953 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6954 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6955 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6956 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6957 http-buffer-request".
6958
6959 Arguments :
6960
6961 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6962 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6963
6964 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006965 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006966 bytes.
6967
6968 Example:
6969 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6970
6971 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6972
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006973http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006974
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006975 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6976 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6977 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006978
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006980http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006981 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6982
6983 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6984 no | yes | yes | yes
6985
6986 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6987 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6988 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6989 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6990 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6991 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6992
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006993 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6994 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006995
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006996 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006998 Example:
6999 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007000
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007001 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007003 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7004 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007005
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007006 Example:
7007 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007008
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007009 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007010
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007011 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7012 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007013
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007014 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7015 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007016
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007017http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007019 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7020 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7021 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7022 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7023 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7024 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7025 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7026 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007028http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007029
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007030 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7031 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7032 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7033 example, or to pass some internal information.
7034 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7035 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7036 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007038http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007039
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007040 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7041 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007042
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007043http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007044
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007045 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007047http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007049 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7050 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7051 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7052 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7053 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7054 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7055 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007057 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7058 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7059 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7060 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7061 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007062
7063 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7064 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7065 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7066 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007068http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007070 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7071 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7072 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7073 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7074 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7075 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007076
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007077http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007078
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007079 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7080 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7081 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7082 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7083 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007085http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007087 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7088 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7089 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7090 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7091 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7092 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007093
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007094http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7095http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7096 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7097 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7098 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7099 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007100
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007101 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7102 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7103 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007104 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007105 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7106 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7107 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007108 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007109 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007110
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007111http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007112
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007113 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7114 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7115 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7116 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7117 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7118 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007119
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007120http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7121 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007122
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007123 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7124 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007125
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007126 Example:
7127 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007128
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007129 # applied to:
7130 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007131
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007132 # outputs:
7133 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007134
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007135 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007136
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007137http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7138 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007139
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007140 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007141 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007143 Example:
7144 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007145
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007146 # applied to:
7147 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007148
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007149 # outputs:
7150 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007151
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007152http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7153 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7154 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007155 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007156 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7157
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007158 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007159 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7160 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007161 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007162 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007163 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007164 are followed to create the response :
7165
7166 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7167 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7168 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7169 ignored.
7170
7171 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7172 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007173 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007174 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7175 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007176
7177 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7178 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7179 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007180 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007181 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007182
7183 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7184 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7185 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007186 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007187 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007188 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007189
7190 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7191 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7192 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7193 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7194 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7195 as a raw content.
7196
7197 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7198 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7199 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7200 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7201 considered as a raw string.
7202
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007203 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7204 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7205 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7206 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7207
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007208 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7209 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007210 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007211
7212 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7213
7214 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007215 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007216 if { status eq 404 }
7217
7218 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7219 string "This is the end !" \
7220 if { status eq 500 }
7221
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007222http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7223http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007224
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007225 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7226 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7227 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007228
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007229http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7230 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007231
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007232 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7233 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7234 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7235 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007236
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007237http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007238
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007239 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7240 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7241 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7242 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7243 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007244
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007245 Arguments:
7246 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007247
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007248 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7249 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007250
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007251http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007252
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007253 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7254 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7255 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007256
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007257http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7258
7259 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7260 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7261 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7262 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7263 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7264
7265http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7266
7267 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7268 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7269 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7270 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7271 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7272 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7273 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7274 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7275 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7276
7277http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7278
7279 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7280 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7281 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7282 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7283 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7284 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7285 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7286
7287http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7288
7289 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7290 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7291 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7292 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7293 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7294 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7295 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7296 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7297
7298http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7299 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7300
7301 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7302 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7303 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7304 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007305
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007306 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007307 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7308 http-response set-status 431
7309 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7310 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007311
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007312http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007313
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007314 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7315 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7316 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7317 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7318 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7319 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7320 based on some information from the request.
7321
7322 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7323
7324http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7325
7326 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7327 inline.
7328
7329 Arguments:
7330 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7331 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7332 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7333 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7334 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7335 (request and response)
7336 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7337 processing
7338 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7339 processing
7340 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7341 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7342 and '_'.
7343
7344 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7345 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007346
7347 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007348 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007349
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007350http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007351
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007352 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7353 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7354 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7355 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7356 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7357 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7358 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7359 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7360 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7361 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7362 action.
7363 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7364 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7365 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7366 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7367 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007368
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007369http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7370
7371 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7372 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7373 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7374 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7375 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007376 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007377 processing.
7378
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007379 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007380 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007381 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007382 rules evaluation.
7383
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007384http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7385http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7386http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007387
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007388 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7389 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7390 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7391 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7392 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007393 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007394
7395http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7396
7397 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7398 about <var-name>.
7399
7400 Example:
7401 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7402
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007403http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7404 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7405
7406 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7407 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7408 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7409 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7410 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7411 buffer is full.
7412
7413 Arguments :
7414
7415 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7416 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7417
7418 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007419 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007420 bytes.
7421
7422 Example:
7423 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007424
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007425http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7426 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7427
7428 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7429 yes | no | yes | yes
7430
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007431 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007432 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7433 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7434 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007435
7436 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7437
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007438 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7439 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7440 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7441 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7442 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7443 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7444 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007445 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007446 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7447 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007448
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007449 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7450 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7451 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7452 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7453 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7454 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7455 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007456 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7457 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7458 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7459 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7460 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7461 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007462
7463 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7464 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7465 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7466 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7467 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7468 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7469 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7470 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007471 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007472 downsides of rare connection failures.
7473
7474 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7475 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7476 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7477 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7478 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7479 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007480 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007481 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7482 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7483 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7484 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7485 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7486
7487 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007488 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7489 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7490 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7491 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007492
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007493 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7494 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007495
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007496 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007497
7498 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7499 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7500 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7501
7502 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7503
7504
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007505http-send-name-header [<header>]
7506 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007507 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7508 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007509 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007510 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7511
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007512 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7513 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7514 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7515 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7516 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7517 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7518 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7519 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7520 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7521 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7522 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7523 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7524 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7525 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7526 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7527 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007528
7529 See also : "server"
7530
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007531id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007532 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7534 no | yes | yes | yes
7535 Arguments : none
7536
7537 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7538 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7539 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007540
7541
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007542ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7543 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7544 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007545 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007546
7547 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7548 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7549 and running).
7550
7551 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7552 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7553 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007554 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007555 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7556
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007557 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7558 "unless" condition is met.
7559
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007560 Example:
7561 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7562 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7563 ignore-persist if url_static
7564
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007565 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7566
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007567load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7568 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7569 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7570 yes | no | yes | yes
7571
7572 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7573 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7574 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007575 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007576 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007577 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7578 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7579 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7580
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007581 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007582 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007583 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007584
7585 Arguments:
7586 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7587 named "server-state-file".
7588
7589 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7590 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7591 name is used as a file name.
7592
7593 none don't load any stat for this backend
7594
7595 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007596 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7597 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7598 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007599 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007600 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007601
7602 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7603 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7604
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007605 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007606
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007607 global
7608 stats socket /tmp/socket
7609 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007610
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007611 defaults
7612 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007613
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007614 backend bk
7615 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7616 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007617
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007618
7619 Then one can run :
7620
7621 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7622
7623 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7624
7625 1
7626 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7627 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7628 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7629
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007630 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007631
7632 global
7633 stats socket /tmp/socket
7634 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7635
7636 defaults
7637 load-server-state-from-file local
7638
7639 backend bk
7640 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7641 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7642
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007643
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007644 Then one can run :
7645
7646 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7647
7648 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7649
7650 1
7651 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7652 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7653 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7654
7655 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7656 "show servers state"
7657
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007658
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007659log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007660log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007661 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007662no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007663 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7665 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007666
7667 Prefix :
7668 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7669 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7670 prefix does not allow arguments.
7671
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007672 Arguments :
7673 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7674 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7675 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7676 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7677 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7678 parameter.
7679
7680 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7681 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7682
7683 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7684 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7685 standard syslog port).
7686
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007687 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7688 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7689 standard syslog port).
7690
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007691 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7692 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7693 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007694 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007695
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007696 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7697 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7698 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7699 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7700 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7701 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7702 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7703 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7704 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7705 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7706 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7707 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007708 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007709 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7710 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7711 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007712 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7713 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007714
7715 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7716 and "fd@2", see above.
7717
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007718 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7719 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7720 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7721 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7722 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7723 having the logs instantly available.
7724
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007725 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7726 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7727 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7728
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007729 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7730 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007731
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007732 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7733 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7734 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7735 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7736 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7737 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7738 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7739 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7740 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7741 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007742 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007743
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007744 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7745 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7746 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7747 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7748 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7749
7750 <sample_size>
7751 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7752 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7753 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7754 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7755 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7756
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007757 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7758 one of the following :
7759
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007760 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7761 field is stripped. This is the default.
7762 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7763 rfc3164.
7764
7765 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007766 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7767
7768 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7769 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7770
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007771 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7772 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7773 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7774 designed to be used with a local log server.
7775
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007776 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7777 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7778 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7779 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7780 systemd logger consumes.
7781
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007782 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7783 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7784 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7785 used with a local log server.
7786
7787 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7788 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7789 designed to be used with a local log server.
7790
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007791 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7792 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7793 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7794 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7795
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007796 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7797
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007798 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7799 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7800 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7801
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007802 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7803 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7804 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7805 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007806
7807 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7808 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7809 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007810 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7811 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7812 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7813 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7814 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007815
7816 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7817
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007818 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7819 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7820 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007821
7822 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7823 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7824 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7825 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7826
7827 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7828 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007829
7830 Example :
7831 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007832 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7833 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7834 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007835 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007836 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7837 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007838 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007839
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007840
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007841log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007842 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7844 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007845
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007846 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7847 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7848 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7849 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7850 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007851
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007852 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7853 "option httplog" directives.
7854
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007855log-format-sd <string>
7856 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7857 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7858 yes | yes | yes | no
7859
7860 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7861 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7862 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7863 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7864 which covers the log format string in depth.
7865
7866 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7867 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7868
7869 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7870 log format to "rfc5424".
7871
7872 Example :
7873 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7874
7875
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007876log-tag <string>
7877 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7878 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7879 yes | yes | yes | yes
7880
7881 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7882 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007883 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007884 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7885 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7886 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7887 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7888 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7889 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007890
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007891max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7892 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7893 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7894 yes | no | yes | yes
7895
7896 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7897 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7898 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7899 servers.
7900
7901 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007902 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007903 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7904 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7905 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007906 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007907 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7908 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7909 picking a different server.
7910
7911 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7912 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7913 even if they have to be queued.
7914
7915 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7916 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7917
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007918max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7919 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7920 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7921 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007922
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007923maxconn <conns>
7924 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7926 yes | yes | yes | no
7927 Arguments :
7928 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7929 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7930 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7931 closes.
7932
7933 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007934 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007935 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7936 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007937 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7938 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7939 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7940 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007941
7942 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7943 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7944 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7945
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007946 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7947 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007948
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007949 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7950
7951
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007952mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007953 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7955 yes | yes | yes | yes
7956 Arguments :
7957 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7958 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7959 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7960 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7961
7962 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7963 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7964 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7965 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7966 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7967
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007968 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7969 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7970 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007971
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007972 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007973 defaults http_instances
7974 mode http
7975
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007976
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007977monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007978 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7980 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007981 Arguments :
7982 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7983 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007984 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007985 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7986 backend and its backup.
7987
7988 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7989 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7990 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7991 servers in a list of backends.
7992
7993 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7994 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7995 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007996 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007997 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7998 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007999 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008000 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8001 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008002
8003 Example:
8004 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008005 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008006 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8007 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8008 monitor-uri /site_alive
8009 monitor fail if site_dead
8010
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008011 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008012
8013
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008014monitor-uri <uri>
8015 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8017 yes | yes | yes | no
8018 Arguments :
8019 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8020 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8021
8022 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8023 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8024 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8025 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8026 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8027 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8028 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8029 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8030
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008031 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008032 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8033 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8034 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8035 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8036 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8037 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008038
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008039 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8040 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8041 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8042 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8043
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008044 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008045 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008046 frontend www
8047 mode http
8048 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8049
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008050 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008051
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008052
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008053option abortonclose
8054no option abortonclose
8055 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8057 yes | no | yes | yes
8058 Arguments : none
8059
8060 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8061 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8062 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8063 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008064 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008065 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8066 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8067 encountered while delivering the response.
8068
8069 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8070 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8071 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8072 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8073 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8074 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008075 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008076 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008077 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008078 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8079 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8080 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8081
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008082 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8083 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008084 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8085 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8086 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8087 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8088 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8089 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008090 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008091
8092 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8093 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8094
8095 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8096
8097
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008098option accept-invalid-http-request
8099no option accept-invalid-http-request
8100 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8102 yes | yes | yes | no
8103 Arguments : none
8104
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008105 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008106 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008107 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008108 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8109 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8110 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8111 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8112 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008113 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8114 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8115 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8116 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008117 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008118 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008119 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8120 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8121 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008122
8123 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8124 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8125 been confirmed.
8126
8127 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8128 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008129 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8130 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008131 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8132
8133 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8134 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8135
8136 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8137 stats socket.
8138
8139
8140option accept-invalid-http-response
8141no option accept-invalid-http-response
8142 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8144 yes | no | yes | yes
8145 Arguments : none
8146
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008147 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008148 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008149 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008150 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8151 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8152 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8153 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8154 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008155 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8156 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8157 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008158
8159 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8160 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8161 been confirmed.
8162
8163 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8164 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8165 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8166 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8167
8168 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8169 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8170
8171 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8172 stats socket.
8173
8174
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008175option allbackups
8176no option allbackups
8177 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8179 yes | no | yes | yes
8180 Arguments : none
8181
8182 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8183 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8184 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8185 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8186 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8187 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8188 order between the backup servers anymore.
8189
8190 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8191 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8192
8193 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8194 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8195
8196
8197option checkcache
8198no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008199 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8201 yes | no | yes | yes
8202 Arguments : none
8203
8204 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8205 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008206 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008207 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8208 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008209 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008210
8211 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008212 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008213 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008214 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8215 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008216 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008217 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008218 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8219 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008220 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008221 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8222 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008223 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008224 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8225 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8226 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8227 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8228 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8229 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8230 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8231 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8232 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8233
8234 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008235 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8236 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8237 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8238 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008239
8240 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8241 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008242 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008243 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008244
8245 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8246 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8247
8248
8249option clitcpka
8250no option clitcpka
8251 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8253 yes | yes | yes | no
8254 Arguments : none
8255
8256 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8257 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008258 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008259 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8260
8261 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8262 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8263 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8264 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8265
8266 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8267 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8268 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8269 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8270 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8271
8272 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8273
8274 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8275 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8276 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8277
8278 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8279 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8280
8281 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8282
8283
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008284option contstats
8285 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8287 yes | yes | yes | no
8288 Arguments : none
8289
8290 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8291 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8292 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008293 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008294 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8295 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8296 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8297 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8298 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008299
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008300option disable-h2-upgrade
8301no option disable-h2-upgrade
8302 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8303 connection.
8304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8305 yes | yes | yes | no
8306 Arguments : none
8307
8308 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8309 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8310 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8311 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008312 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8313 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8314 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8315 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8316 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8317 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008318
8319 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8320 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008321
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008322option dontlog-normal
8323no option dontlog-normal
8324 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8326 yes | yes | yes | no
8327 Arguments : none
8328
8329 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8330 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8331 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8332 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8333 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8334 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8335 logged.
8336
8337 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8338 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8339 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008341 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008342 logging.
8343
8344
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008345option dontlognull
8346no option dontlognull
8347 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8349 yes | yes | yes | no
8350 Arguments : none
8351
8352 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8353 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8354 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8355 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8356 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8357 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008358 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8359 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8360 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008361
8362 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008363 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008364 would not be logged.
8365
8366 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8367 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8368
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008369 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008370 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008371
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008372
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008373option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008374 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8376 yes | yes | yes | yes
8377 Arguments :
8378 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8379 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008380 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008381 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008382
8383 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8384 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8385 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8386 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8387 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8388 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8389 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008390 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8391 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8392 possible that the client has already brought one.
8393
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008394 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008395 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008396 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008397 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008398 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008399 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008400
8401 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8402 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8403 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8404 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8405 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8406 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008407 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008408
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008409 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8410 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008411 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008412 are under the control of the end-user.
8413
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008414 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008415 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8416 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008417 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8418 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8419 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008420
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008421 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008422 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8423 frontend www
8424 mode http
8425 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8426
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008427 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8428 backend www
8429 mode http
8430 option forwardfor header X-Client
8431
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008432 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008433 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008434
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008435
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008436option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8437no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8438 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8440 yes | yes | yes | no
8441 Arguments : none
8442
8443 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8444 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8445 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8446 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8447 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8448 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8449 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8450
8451 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8452 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8453 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8454 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8455 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8456 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8457 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8458 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8459 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8460 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8461
8462 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8463
8464 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8465 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8466
8467 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8468 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8469
8470
8471option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8472no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8473 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8475 yes | no | yes | yes
8476 Arguments : none
8477
8478 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8479 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8480 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8481 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8482 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8483 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8484 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8485
8486 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8487 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8488 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8489 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8490 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8491 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8492 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8493 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8494 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8495 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8496
8497 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8498
8499 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8500 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8501
8502 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8503 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8504
8505
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008506option http-buffer-request
8507no option http-buffer-request
8508 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8510 yes | yes | yes | yes
8511 Arguments : none
8512
8513 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8514 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8515 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8516 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8517 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8518 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008519 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8520 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8521 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8522 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008523
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008524 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8525 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008526
8527
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008528option http-ignore-probes
8529no option http-ignore-probes
8530 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8532 yes | yes | yes | no
8533 Arguments : none
8534
8535 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8536 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8537 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8538 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8539 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8540 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8541 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8542 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8543 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008544 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8545 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008546 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8547
8548 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8549 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8550 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8551 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8552 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8553 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8554 are often the only way to detect them.
8555
8556 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8557 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8558
8559 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8560
8561
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008562option http-keep-alive
8563no option http-keep-alive
8564 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8566 yes | yes | yes | yes
8567 Arguments : none
8568
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008569 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8570 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008571 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8572 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008573 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8574 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8575 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008576
8577 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8578 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008579 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8580 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8581 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8582 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8583 situations where this option may be useful :
8584
8585 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008586 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008587
8588 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8589 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8590
8591 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8592 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8593 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8594 request.
8595
8596 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8597 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008598 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8599 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8600 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008601
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008602 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8603 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8604 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8605 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8606 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8607 not set.
8608
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008609 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8610 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8611 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008612
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008613 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008614 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008615 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008616
8617
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008618option http-no-delay
8619no option http-no-delay
8620 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8622 yes | yes | yes | yes
8623 Arguments : none
8624
8625 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8626 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8627 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8628 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8629 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8630 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8631 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008632 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008633 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8634 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8635 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8636 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8637 affected.
8638
8639 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8640 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8641 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8642 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8643 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8644 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8645 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8646 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8647 latency environments.
8648
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008649 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8650
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008651
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008652option http-pretend-keepalive
8653no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008654 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008656 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008657 Arguments : none
8658
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008659 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008660 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8661 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8662 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008663 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008664 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8665 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8666 consider the response complete.
8667
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008668 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008669 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008670 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008671 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008672 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008673 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8674
8675 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8676 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8677 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8678 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008679 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8680 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008681 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8682
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008683 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8684 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8685 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8686 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8687 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8688 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008689
8690 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8691 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8692
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008693 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008694 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008695
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008696
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008697option http-server-close
8698no option http-server-close
8699 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8701 yes | yes | yes | yes
8702 Arguments : none
8703
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008704 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8705 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8706 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8707 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008708 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8709 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8710 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8711 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8712 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8713 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8714 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8715 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8716 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8717 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8718 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008719
8720 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8721 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8722 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8723 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008724 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8725 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008726
8727 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8728 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008729 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8730 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8731 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008732
8733 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8734 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8735
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008736 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8737 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008738
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008739option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008740no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008741 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8743 yes | yes | yes | no
8744 Arguments : none
8745
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008746 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008747 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8748 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8749 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8750 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8751 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008752 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008753
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008754 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008755 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008756 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8757 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8758 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008759
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008760 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8761 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8762 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8763 front of an existing proxy.
8764
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008765 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8766
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008767 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008768
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008769option httpchk
8770option httpchk <uri>
8771option httpchk <method> <uri>
8772option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008773 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8775 yes | no | yes | yes
8776 Arguments :
8777 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8778 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8779 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8780 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8781 ones.
8782
8783 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8784 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8785 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8786
8787 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8788 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8789 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008790 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008791
8792 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8793 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8794 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8795 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8796 the lack of any response.
8797
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008798 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8799 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8800 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8801 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8802
8803 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8804 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8805 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008806
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008807 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8808 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008809 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008810 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008811 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008812
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008813 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8814 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8815 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8816 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8817
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008818 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008819 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8820 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8821 backend https_relay
8822 mode tcp
8823 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8824 http-check send hdr Host www
8825 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008826
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008827 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8828 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8829 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008830
8831
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008832option httpclose
8833no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008834 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8836 yes | yes | yes | yes
8837 Arguments : none
8838
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008839 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8840 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8841 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8842 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008843 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008844
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008845 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8846 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008847 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008848 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8849 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008850
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008851 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8852 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8853 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008854
8855 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8856 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008857 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8858 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8859 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008860
8861 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8862 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8863
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008864 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008865
8866
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008867option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008868 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008870 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008871 Arguments :
8872 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8873 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8874 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008875 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008876 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008877
8878 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8879 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8880 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8881 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8882 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8883 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8884 ports.
8885
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008886 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8887 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008888
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008889 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008891 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008892
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008893
8894option http_proxy
8895no option http_proxy
8896 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8898 yes | yes | yes | yes
8899 Arguments : none
8900
8901 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8902 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8903 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8904 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8905 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8906
8907 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8908 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008909 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8910 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008911
8912 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8913 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8914
8915 Example :
8916 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8917 backend direct_forward
8918 option httpclose
8919 option http_proxy
8920
8921 See also : "option httpclose"
8922
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008923
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008924option independent-streams
8925no option independent-streams
8926 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8928 yes | yes | yes | yes
8929 Arguments : none
8930
8931 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8932 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8933 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8934 receive data or not.
8935
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008936 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008937 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8938 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8939 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8940 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8941 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8942 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8943 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8944 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8945 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8946 socket buffers.
8947
8948 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8949 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8950 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8951 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8952 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8953
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008954 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008955
8956
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008957option ldap-check
8958 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8960 yes | no | yes | yes
8961 Arguments : none
8962
8963 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8964 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8965 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8966 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8967
8968 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8969 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8970
8971 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8972 configure it.
8973
8974 Example :
8975 option ldap-check
8976
8977 See also : "option httpchk"
8978
8979
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008980option external-check
8981 Use external processes for server health checks
8982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8983 yes | no | yes | yes
8984
8985 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8986 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8987 command".
8988
8989 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8990
8991 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8992
8993
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008994option log-health-checks
8995no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008996 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8998 yes | no | yes | yes
8999 Arguments : none
9000
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009001 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9002 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9003 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009004
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009005 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9006 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9007 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9008 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9009 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9010
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009011 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009012 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009013
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009014 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9015 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9016 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009017
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009018
9019option log-separate-errors
9020no option log-separate-errors
9021 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9023 yes | yes | yes | no
9024 Arguments : none
9025
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009026 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009027 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9028 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9029 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9030 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9031 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9032 provides very important information.
9033
9034 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9035 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9036 error logs.
9037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009038 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009039 logging.
9040
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009041
9042option logasap
9043no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009044 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9046 yes | yes | yes | no
9047 Arguments : none
9048
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009049 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9050 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9051 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9052 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9053
9054 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9055 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9056 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9057 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9058 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009059 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009060 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9061 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9062 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9063 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009064 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009065
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009066 Examples :
9067 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9068 mode http
9069 option httplog
9070 option logasap
9071 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9072
9073 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9074 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9075 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9076 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009078 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009079 logging.
9080
9081
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009082option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009083 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9085 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009086 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009087 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9088 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009089 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9090 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009091
9092 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9093 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009094 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009095 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009096 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9097 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9098 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009099
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009100 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9101 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9102 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009103
9104 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009105 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009106 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9107 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9108 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9109 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9110 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9111 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9112 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9113
9114 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9115 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009116
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009117 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009118
9119 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9120 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9121 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9122 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009123 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009124 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009125
9126 See also: "option httpchk"
9127
9128
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009129option nolinger
9130no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009131 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009132 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9133 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009134 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009135
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009136 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009137 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9138 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9139 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9140 connections.
9141
9142 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9143 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009144 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9145 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9146 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9147 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9148 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9149 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9150 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9151 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9152 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9153 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9154 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9155 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9156 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009157
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009158 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9159 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9160 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9161 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9162 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009163
9164 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9165 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009166 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009167 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009168 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009169
9170 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9171 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9172
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009173 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9174 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009175
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009176option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9177 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9179 yes | yes | yes | yes
9180 Arguments :
9181 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9182 matching <network>
9183 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9184 header name.
9185
9186 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9187 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9188 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9189 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9190 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9191 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9192 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9193 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9194 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9195 possible that the client has already brought one.
9196
9197 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9198 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9199 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9200 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9201 header and requires different one.
9202
9203 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9204 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9205 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009206 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9207 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9208 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9209 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9210 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009211
9212 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9213 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9214 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9215 both are defined.
9216
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009217 Examples :
9218 # Original Destination address
9219 frontend www
9220 mode http
9221 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9222
9223 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9224 backend www
9225 mode http
9226 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9227
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009228 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009229
9230
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009231option persist
9232no option persist
9233 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9234 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9235 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009236 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009237
9238 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9239 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9240 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9241 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9242 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9243 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9244 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9245 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9246 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9247 redirected to another valid server.
9248
9249 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9250 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9251
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009252 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009253
9254
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009255option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9256 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9258 yes | no | yes | yes
9259 Arguments :
9260 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9261 PostgreSQL server.
9262
9263 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9264 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9265 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9266 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9267
9268 See also: "option httpchk"
9269
9270
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009271option prefer-last-server
9272no option prefer-last-server
9273 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9274 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9275 yes | no | yes | yes
9276 Arguments : none
9277
9278 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009279 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009280 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9281 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009282 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009283 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009284 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009285 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9286 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009287 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009288 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009289 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9290 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9291 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009292 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9293 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9294 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009295
9296 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9297 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9298
9299 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9300
9301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009302option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009303option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009304no option redispatch
9305 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9306 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9307 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009308 Arguments :
9309 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9310 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9311 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009312 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009313 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009314 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009315 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9316 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9317 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9318
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009319
9320 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9321 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9322 be able to access the service anymore.
9323
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009324 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9325 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009326
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009327 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9328 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9329 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9330 following order:
9331
9332 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9333
9334 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9335 list, or
9336
9337 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9338
9339 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9340 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9341
9342 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9343 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9344 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9345 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9346
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009347 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009348 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9349 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009351 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9352 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9353
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009354 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009355
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009356
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009357option redis-check
9358 Use redis health checks for server testing
9359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9360 yes | no | yes | yes
9361 Arguments : none
9362
9363 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9364 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9365 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9366 find the "+PONG" response message.
9367
9368 Example :
9369 option redis-check
9370
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009371 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009372
9373
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009374option smtpchk
9375option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9376 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9378 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009379 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009380 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009381 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009382 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9383
9384 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9385 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9386 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9387
9388 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9389 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9390 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9391 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9392 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9393 dead server.
9394
9395 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9396 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009397 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009398 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9399
9400 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9401 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9402 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9403 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009404 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009405
9406 Example :
9407 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9408
9409 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9410
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009412option socket-stats
9413no option socket-stats
9414
9415 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9417 yes | yes | yes | no
9418
9419 Arguments : none
9420
9421
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009422option splice-auto
9423no option splice-auto
9424 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9426 yes | yes | yes | yes
9427 Arguments : none
9428
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009429 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009430 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009431 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009432 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009433 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009434 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9435 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9436 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9437 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9438
9439 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9440 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9441 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9442 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9443 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9444 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9445 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9446 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9447 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9448 keyword.
9449
9450 Example :
9451 option splice-auto
9452
9453 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9454 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9455
9456 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9457 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9458
9459
9460option splice-request
9461no option splice-request
9462 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9464 yes | yes | yes | yes
9465 Arguments : none
9466
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009467 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009468 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009469 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9470 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9471 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9472 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9473
9474 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9475
9476 Example :
9477 option splice-request
9478
9479 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9480 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9481
9482 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9483 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9484
9485
9486option splice-response
9487no option splice-response
9488 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9490 yes | yes | yes | yes
9491 Arguments : none
9492
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009493 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009494 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009495 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9496 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9497 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9498 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9499
9500 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9501
9502 Example :
9503 option splice-response
9504
9505 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9506 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9507
9508 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9509 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9510
9511
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009512option spop-check
9513 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9515 no | no | no | yes
9516 Arguments : none
9517
9518 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9519 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9520 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9521 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9522
9523 Example :
9524 option spop-check
9525
9526 See also : "option httpchk"
9527
9528
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009529option srvtcpka
9530no option srvtcpka
9531 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9533 yes | no | yes | yes
9534 Arguments : none
9535
9536 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9537 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009538 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009539 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9540
9541 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9542 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9543 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9544 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9545
9546 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9547 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9548 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9549 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9550 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9551
9552 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9553
9554 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9555 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9556 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9557
9558 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9559 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9560
9561 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9562
9563
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009564option ssl-hello-chk
9565 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9567 yes | no | yes | yes
9568 Arguments : none
9569
9570 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9571 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9572 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9573 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9574 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9575 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9576 hello message.
9577
9578 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9579 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9580 messages, which is appreciable.
9581
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009582 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009583 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9584 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009585
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009586 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9587
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009588
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009589option tcp-check
9590 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9591 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9592 yes | no | yes | yes
9593
9594 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9595 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9596
9597 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9598 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9599 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9600
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009601 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009602 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9603 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9604 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9605 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9606 only.
9607
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009608 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009609 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009610 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9611 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9612 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9613
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009614 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009615 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9616 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009617 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009618 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9619 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9620 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9621 the respective protocols.
9622 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009623 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009624
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009625 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009626
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009627 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9628 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9629 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9630 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009631
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009632 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9633 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9634 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009635
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009636
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009637 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009638 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009639 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009640 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009641
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009642 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009643 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009644 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009645
9646 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9647 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009648 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009649 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009650 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009651 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009652 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009653 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009654 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9655 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009656 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009657 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9658 tcp-check expect string +OK
9659
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009660 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009661 (send many headers before analyzing)
9662 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009663 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009664 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9665 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9666 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9667 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009668 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009669
9670
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009671 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009672
9673
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009674option tcp-smart-accept
9675no option tcp-smart-accept
9676 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9678 yes | yes | yes | no
9679 Arguments : none
9680
9681 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9682 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9683 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9684 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9685 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9686 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9687
9688 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9689 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9690 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9691 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9692
9693 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9694 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9695 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009696 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009697
9698 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9699 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9700 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9701
9702 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9703 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9704 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9705
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009706 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9707
9708
9709option tcp-smart-connect
9710no option tcp-smart-connect
9711 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9713 yes | no | yes | yes
9714 Arguments : none
9715
9716 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9717 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9718 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9719 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9720 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9721
9722 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9723 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9724 complex.
9725
9726 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9727 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9728 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9729
9730 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9731 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9732
9733 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9734
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009735
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009736option tcpka
9737 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9739 yes | yes | yes | yes
9740 Arguments : none
9741
9742 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9743 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009744 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009745 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9746
9747 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9748 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9749 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9750 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9751
9752 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9753 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9754 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9755 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9756 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9757
9758 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9759
9760 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9761 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9762 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9763 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9764 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9765 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9766 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9767 backends.
9768
9769 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9770
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009771
9772option tcplog
9773 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009775 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009776 Arguments : none
9777
9778 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9779 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9780 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9781 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9782 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9783 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9784 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9785 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9786
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009787 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009789 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009790
9791
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009792option transparent
9793no option transparent
9794 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009796 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009797 Arguments : none
9798
9799 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9800 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9801 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9802 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9803 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9804 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9805 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9806 appropriate server.
9807
9808 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9809 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9810
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009811 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009812 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009813
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009814
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009815external-check command <command>
9816 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9818 yes | no | yes | yes
9819
9820 Arguments :
9821 <command> is the external command to run
9822
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009823 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9824
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009825 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009826
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009827 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9828 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9829 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9830 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9831 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9832 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009833
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009834 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9835
9836 Environment variables :
9837 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9838 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9839
9840 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9841
9842 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9843
9844 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9845 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9846 for a UNIX socket).
9847
9848 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9849
9850 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9851
9852 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9853
9854 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9855
9856 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9857
9858 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9859 socket).
9860
9861 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9862 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9863
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009864 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9865
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009866 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9867 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9868 failed.
9869
9870 Example :
9871 external-check command /bin/true
9872
9873 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9874
9875
9876external-check path <path>
9877 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9879 yes | no | yes | yes
9880
9881 Arguments :
9882 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9883
9884 The default path is "".
9885
9886 Example :
9887 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9888
9889 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9890 "external-check command"
9891
9892
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009893persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009894persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009895 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9897 yes | no | yes | yes
9898 Arguments :
9899 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009900 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9901 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009902
9903 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9904 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009905 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009906 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9907 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9908 forwarded to this server.
9909
9910 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9911 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9912 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009913 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009914 a single "listen" section.
9915
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009916 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9917 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9918 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9919
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009920 Example :
9921 listen tse-farm
9922 bind :3389
9923 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9924 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9925 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9926 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9927 persist rdp-cookie
9928 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009929 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009930 balance rdp-cookie
9931 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9932 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9933
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009934 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9935 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009936
9937
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009938rate-limit sessions <rate>
9939 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9941 yes | yes | yes | no
9942 Arguments :
9943 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9944 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9945
9946 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9947 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9948 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009949 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009950 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9951 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9952
9953 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9954 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9955 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9956 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9957
9958 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9959 listen smtp
9960 mode tcp
9961 bind :25
9962 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009963 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009964
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009965 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9966 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9967 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009968
9969 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9970
9971
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009972redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9973redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9974redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009975 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9977 no | yes | yes | yes
9978
9979 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009980 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009981
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009982 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009983 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009984 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9985 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9986 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009987
9988 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9989 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9990 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9991 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9992 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009993 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9994 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9995 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9996 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009997
9998 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9999 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10000 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10001 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10002 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10003 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010004 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010005 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010006 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10007 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10008 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010009
10010 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010011 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10012 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10013 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010014 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010015 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10016 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10017 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10018 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010019
10020 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010021 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010022
10023 - "drop-query"
10024 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10025 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10026 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10027 with a location-type redirect.
10028
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010029 - "append-slash"
10030 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10031 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10032 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10033 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10034
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010035 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10036 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10037 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10038 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10039 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10040 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10041 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10042
10043 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10044 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10045 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10046 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10047 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10048 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10049 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010050
10051 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10052 acl clear dst_port 80
10053 acl secure dst_port 8080
10054 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010055 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010056 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010057 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10058
10059 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010060 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10061 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10062 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010063 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010064
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010065 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10066 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10067 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10068
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010069 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010070 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010071
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010072 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010073 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10074 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10075 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010077 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010078
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010079
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010080retries <value>
10081 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10082 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10083 yes | no | yes | yes
10084 Arguments :
10085 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10086 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10087 default value is 3.
10088
10089 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10090 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10091 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10092
10093 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010094 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10095 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010096
10097 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10098 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10099
10100 See also : "option redispatch"
10101
10102
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010103retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010104 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10105 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10106 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010107 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10108 yes | no | yes | yes
10109 Arguments :
10110 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10111 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10112 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10113 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10114
10115 none never retry
10116
10117 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10118 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10119
10120 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10121 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10122 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10123 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10124 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10125 processing the request.
10126
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010127 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10128 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10129 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10130 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10131 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10132 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10133 overflow attack for example).
10134
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010135 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10136 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10137 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10138 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10139 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10140 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10141 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10142 amplify denial of service attacks.
10143
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010144 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10145 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10146 considered to be safe to retry.
10147
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010148 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10149 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10150 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10151 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10152 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010153
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010154 all-retryable-errors
10155 retry request for any error that are considered
10156 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10157 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10158 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10159
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010160 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10161 not cumulative.
10162
10163 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10164 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10165 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10166 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10167
10168 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10169 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10170 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10171 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10172 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10173 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10174 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10175 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10176 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10177 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10178 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10179 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10180
10181 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10182 should not use this directive.
10183
10184 The default is "conn-failure".
10185
10186 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10187
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010188server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010189 Declare a server in a backend
10190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10191 no | no | yes | yes
10192 Arguments :
10193 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010194 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010195 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010196
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010197 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10198 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10199 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10200 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010201 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10202 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010203 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010204 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10205 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010206 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10207 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10208 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10209 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10210 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10211 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10212 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010213 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010214 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10215 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10216 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10217 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10218 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10219 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010220 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10221 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010222 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10223 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010224
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010225 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010226 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10227 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10228 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10229 adding this value to the client's port.
10230
10231 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10232 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010233 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010234
10235 Examples :
10236 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10237 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010238 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010239 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10240 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10241 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010242
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010243 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10244 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10245 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10246 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10247 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10248
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010249 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10250 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010251
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010252server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010253 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010254 this backend.
10255 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10256 no | no | yes | yes
10257
10258 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10259 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10260 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10261 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10262 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010263
10264 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10265 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10266
10267 global
10268 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10269
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010270 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010271 load-server-state-from-file
10272
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010273 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010274 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010275
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010276server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10277 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10278 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10280 no | no | yes | yes
10281
10282 Arguments:
10283 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10284
10285 <num | range>
10286 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10287 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10288 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10289 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10290
10291 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10292
10293 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10294
10295 <params*>
10296 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10297 keyword.
10298
10299 Examples:
10300 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10301 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10302 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10303
10304 # or
10305 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10306
10307 # would be equivalent to:
10308 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10309 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10310 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10311
10312
10313
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010314source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010315source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010316source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010317 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10319 yes | no | yes | yes
10320 Arguments :
10321 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10322 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010323
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010324 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010325 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10326 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10327 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10328 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10329 supported prefixes are :
10330 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10331 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10332 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010333 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010334 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10335 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010336
10337 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10338 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010339 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10340 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10341 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010342
10343 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10344 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10345 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10346 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10347 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10348 <addr>.
10349
10350 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10351 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10352 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10353 port.
10354
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010355 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10356 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10357 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10358 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010359 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010360 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10361 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10362 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10363 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10364 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10365 HTTP header.
10366
10367 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10368 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010369 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010370 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10371 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10372 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10373 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10374 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10375 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10376 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10377
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010378 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10379 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10380 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10381 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10382 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10383 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10384
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010385 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10386 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10387 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10388 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10389
10390 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10391 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10392 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10393 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10394 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10395 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10396
10397 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10398 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10399 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10400 there are two methods :
10401
10402 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10403 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10404 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10405 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10406 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10407 of the client ranges may be used.
10408
10409 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10410 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10411 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10412 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10413 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10414 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10415 same session.
10416
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010417 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10418 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10419 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010420 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010421
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010422 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10423
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010424 Examples :
10425 backend private
10426 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10427 source 192.168.1.200
10428
10429 backend transparent_ssl1
10430 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10431 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10432
10433 backend transparent_ssl2
10434 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10435 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10436 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10437
10438 backend transparent_ssl3
10439 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10440 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10441 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10442
10443 backend transparent_smtp
10444 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10445 # with Tproxy version 4.
10446 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10447
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010448 backend transparent_http
10449 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10450 # proxy.
10451 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010453 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010454 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10455
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010456
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010457srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10458 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10459 the connection on the server side.
10460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10461 yes | no | yes | yes
10462 Arguments :
10463 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10464
10465 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10466 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010467 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10468 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010469
10470 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10471
10472
10473srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10474 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10475 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10476 server side.
10477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10478 yes | no | yes | yes
10479 Arguments :
10480 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10481 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10482 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10483 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10484
10485 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10486 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010487 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10488 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010489
10490 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10491
10492
10493srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10494 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10496 yes | no | yes | yes
10497 Arguments :
10498 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10499 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10500 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10501 document.
10502
10503 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10504 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010505 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10506 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010507
10508 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10509
10510
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010511stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10512 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010514 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010515
10516 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10517 matched.
10518
10519 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10520 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10521
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010522 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10523 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010524 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010525
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010526 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10527 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10528 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10529 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010530
10531 Example :
10532 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10533 backend stats_localhost
10534 stats enable
10535 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10536
10537 Example :
10538 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10539 backend stats_auth
10540 stats enable
10541 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10542 stats admin if TRUE
10543
10544 Example :
10545 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10546 userlist stats-auth
10547 group admin users admin
10548 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10549 group readonly users haproxy
10550 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10551
10552 backend stats_auth
10553 stats enable
10554 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10555 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10556 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10557 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10558
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010559 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10560 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10561 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010562
10563
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010564stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10565 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010567 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010568 Arguments :
10569 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10570
10571 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10572
10573 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10574 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10575 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10576 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10577 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10578 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10579
10580 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10581 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10582 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010583 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010584
10585 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10586 report using "stats scope".
10587
10588 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10589 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10590 unobvious parameters.
10591
10592 Example :
10593 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10594 backend public_www
10595 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10596 stats enable
10597 stats hide-version
10598 stats scope .
10599 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010600 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010601 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10602 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10603
10604 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10605 backend private_monitoring
10606 stats enable
10607 stats uri /admin?stats
10608 stats refresh 5s
10609
10610 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10611
10612
10613stats enable
10614 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010616 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010617 Arguments : none
10618
10619 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10620 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10621 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10622 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10623 - stats auth : no authentication
10624 - stats scope : no restriction
10625
10626 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10627 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10628 unobvious parameters.
10629
10630 Example :
10631 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10632 backend public_www
10633 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10634 stats enable
10635 stats hide-version
10636 stats scope .
10637 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010638 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010639 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10640 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10641
10642 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10643 backend private_monitoring
10644 stats enable
10645 stats uri /admin?stats
10646 stats refresh 5s
10647
10648 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10649
10650
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010651stats hide-version
10652 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010654 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010655 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010656
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010657 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10658 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10659 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10660 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10661 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10662 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010663
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010664 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10665 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10666 unobvious parameters.
10667
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010668 Example :
10669 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10670 backend public_www
10671 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010672 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010673 stats hide-version
10674 stats scope .
10675 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010676 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010677 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10678 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010679
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010680 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10681 backend private_monitoring
10682 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010683 stats uri /admin?stats
10684 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010685
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010686 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010687
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010688
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010689stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10690 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10691 Access control for statistics
10692
10693 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10694 no | no | yes | yes
10695
10696 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10697 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10698 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10699 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10700 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10701 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10702
10703 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10704 instance.
10705
10706 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10707 about ACL usage.
10708
10709
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010710stats realm <realm>
10711 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010713 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010714 Arguments :
10715 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10716 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10717 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10718
10719 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10720 using a backslash ('\').
10721
10722 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10723 only related to authentication.
10724
10725 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10726 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10727 unobvious parameters.
10728
10729 Example :
10730 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10731 backend public_www
10732 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10733 stats enable
10734 stats hide-version
10735 stats scope .
10736 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010737 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010738 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10739 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10740
10741 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10742 backend private_monitoring
10743 stats enable
10744 stats uri /admin?stats
10745 stats refresh 5s
10746
10747 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10748
10749
10750stats refresh <delay>
10751 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010753 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010754 Arguments :
10755 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10756 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10757 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10758 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10759 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10760 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10761
10762 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10763 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10764 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010765 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010766
10767 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10768 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10769 unobvious parameters.
10770
10771 Example :
10772 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10773 backend public_www
10774 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10775 stats enable
10776 stats hide-version
10777 stats scope .
10778 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010779 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010780 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10781 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10782
10783 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10784 backend private_monitoring
10785 stats enable
10786 stats uri /admin?stats
10787 stats refresh 5s
10788
10789 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10790
10791
10792stats scope { <name> | "." }
10793 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010795 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010796 Arguments :
10797 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10798 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10799 section in which the statement appears.
10800
10801 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10802 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10803 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10804 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10805 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10806 exists.
10807
10808 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10809 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10810 unobvious parameters.
10811
10812 Example :
10813 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10814 backend public_www
10815 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10816 stats enable
10817 stats hide-version
10818 stats scope .
10819 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010820 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010821 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10822 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10823
10824 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10825 backend private_monitoring
10826 stats enable
10827 stats uri /admin?stats
10828 stats refresh 5s
10829
10830 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10831
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010832
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010833stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010834 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010836 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010837
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010838 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010839 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10840
10841 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10842 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10843
10844 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10845 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010846 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010847
10848 Example :
10849 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10850 backend private_monitoring
10851 stats enable
10852 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10853 stats uri /admin?stats
10854 stats refresh 5s
10855
10856 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10857 global section.
10858
10859
10860stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010861 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10863 yes | yes | yes | yes
10864 Arguments : none
10865
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010866 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010867 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10868 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10869 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10870 - IP (socket, server)
10871 - cookie (backend, server)
10872
10873 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10874 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010875 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010876
10877 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10878
10879
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010880stats show-modules
10881 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10883 yes | yes | yes | yes
10884 Arguments : none
10885
10886 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10887 values as a tooltip.
10888
10889 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10890 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10891 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10892
10893 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10894
10895
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010896stats show-node [ <name> ]
10897 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010899 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010900 Arguments:
10901 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10902 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10903
10904 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10905 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010906 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010907
10908 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10909 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10910 unobvious parameters.
10911
10912 Example:
10913 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10914 backend private_monitoring
10915 stats enable
10916 stats show-node Europe-1
10917 stats uri /admin?stats
10918 stats refresh 5s
10919
10920 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10921 section.
10922
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010923
10924stats uri <prefix>
10925 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010927 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010928 Arguments :
10929 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10930 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10931 query string.
10932
10933 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10934 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10935 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10936 possible to reach it in the application.
10937
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010938 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010939 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010940 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10941 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10942 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10943 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10944
10945 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10946 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10947 an address or a port to statistics only.
10948
10949 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10950 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10951 unobvious parameters.
10952
10953 Example :
10954 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10955 backend public_www
10956 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10957 stats enable
10958 stats hide-version
10959 stats scope .
10960 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010961 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010962 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10963 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10964
10965 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10966 backend private_monitoring
10967 stats enable
10968 stats uri /admin?stats
10969 stats refresh 5s
10970
10971 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10972
10973
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010974stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10975 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010977 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010978
10979 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010980 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010981 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010982 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010983 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10984
10985 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10986 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10987 the "stick-table" statement.
10988
10989 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10990 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10991 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10992 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10993 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10994
10995 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10996 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10997 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10998 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10999 transformation rules.
11000
11001 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11002 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11003 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11004 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11005 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11006 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11007 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11008
11009 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11010 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11011 ACL based conditions.
11012
11013 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11014 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11015 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11016 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11017
11018 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11019 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11020 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11021 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11022
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011023 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11024 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011025 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011026
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011027 Example :
11028 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11029 # last 30 minutes
11030 backend pop
11031 mode tcp
11032 balance roundrobin
11033 stick store-request src
11034 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11035 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11036 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11037
11038 backend smtp
11039 mode tcp
11040 balance roundrobin
11041 stick match src table pop
11042 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11043 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11044
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011045 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011046 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011047
11048
11049stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11050 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11052 no | no | yes | yes
11053
11054 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11055 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11056 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11057 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11058
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011059 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11060 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011061 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011062
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011063 Examples :
11064 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011065 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011066
11067 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11068 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11069 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11070
11071
11072 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11073 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11074 backend http
11075 mode http
11076 balance roundrobin
11077 stick on src table https
11078 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11079 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11080 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11081
11082 backend https
11083 mode tcp
11084 balance roundrobin
11085 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11086 stick on src
11087 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11088 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11089
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011090 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011091
11092
11093stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11094 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11096 no | no | yes | yes
11097
11098 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011099 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011100 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011101 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011102 server is selected.
11103
11104 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11105 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11106 the "stick-table" statement.
11107
11108 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11109 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11110 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11111 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11112 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11113 address.
11114
11115 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11116 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11117 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11118 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11119 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11120 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11121 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11122 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11123 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11124 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11125
11126 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11127 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11128 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11129 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11130 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11131 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11132 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11133
11134 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11135 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11136 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11137 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11138
11139 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11140 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11141 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11142 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11143 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11144 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011145 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11146 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11147 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11148 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11149 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11150 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011151
11152 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11153 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11154 the request.
11155
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011156 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11157 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011158 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011159
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011160 Example :
11161 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11162 # last 30 minutes
11163 backend pop
11164 mode tcp
11165 balance roundrobin
11166 stick store-request src
11167 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11168 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11169 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11170
11171 backend smtp
11172 mode tcp
11173 balance roundrobin
11174 stick match src table pop
11175 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11176 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11177
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011178 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011179 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011180
11181
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011182stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011183 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011184 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011185 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011187 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011188
11189 Arguments :
11190 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11191 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11192 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11193 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11194
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011195 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11196 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11197 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11198 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11199
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011200 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11201 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11202 instance.
11203
11204 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11205 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11206 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11207 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11208 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11209 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011210 to 32 characters.
11211
11212 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11213 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11214 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011215 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011216 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11217 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011218
11219 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011220 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11221 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011222 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11223 increase.
11224
11225 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011226 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11227 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11228 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011229
11230 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011231 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011232 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11233 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011234 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011235 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11236 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11237 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11238 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11239 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11240 parameter (see below).
11241
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011242 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11243 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11244 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11245 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11246 soft restart.
11247
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011248 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11249 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011250
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011251 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11252 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11253 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11254 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011255 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011256 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011257 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11258 if not expiration delay is specified.
11259
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011260 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11261 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11262 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11263 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11264 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11265 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11266 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11267 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11268 token.
11269
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011270 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11271 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11272 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11273 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011274 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11275 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11276 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11277 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11278 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11279 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11280 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11281 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11282 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11283 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11284 types and their arguments.
11285
11286 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11287 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11288 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11289 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11290
11291 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11292 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11293 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011294 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011295
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011296 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11297 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11298 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011299 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011300 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011301 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011302
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011303 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11304 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11305 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11306 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11307
11308 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11309 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11310 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11311 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11312 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11313 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11314
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011315 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11316 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11317 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11318 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11319
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011320 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11321 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11322 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11323 they were received.
11324
11325 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11326 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11327 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11328 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11329 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11330
11331 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11332 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11333 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11334 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11335 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11336
11337 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11338 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11339 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11340
11341 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11342 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11343 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11344 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11345 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11346
11347 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11348 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11349 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11350 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11351 the client side.
11352
11353 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11354 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11355 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11356 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11357 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11358 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11359 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11360
11361 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11362 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11363 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11364 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11365 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11366 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011367 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011368
11369 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11370 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11371 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11372 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11373 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11374 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11375
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011376 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11377 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11378 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11379 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11380 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11381
11382 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11383 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11384 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11385 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11386 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11387 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11388
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011389 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011390 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011391 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11392 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11393
11394 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11395 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11396 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11397 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11398 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11399 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11400 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11401 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11402 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11403 recommended for better fairness.
11404
11405 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011406 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011407 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11408 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11409
11410 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11411 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11412 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11413 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11414 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11415 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11416 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11417 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11418 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11419 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011420
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011421 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11422 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011423 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11424 reference it.
11425
11426 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11427 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011428 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11429 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11430 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011431
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011432 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11433 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11434 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11435 something that can be ignored.
11436
11437 Example:
11438 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11439 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11440 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11441 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11442
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011443 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011444 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011445
11446
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011447stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011448 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11450 no | no | yes | yes
11451
11452 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011453 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011454 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011455 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011456 server is selected.
11457
11458 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11459 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11460 the "stick-table" statement.
11461
11462 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11463 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11464 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11465 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11466
11467 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11468 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11469 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11470 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11471 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11472 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011473 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011474 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11475 rules.
11476
11477 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11478 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11479 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11480 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11481 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11482 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11483 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11484
11485 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11486 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11487 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11488 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11489
11490 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11491 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11492 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11493 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11494 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11495 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011496 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11497 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11498 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11499 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11500 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11501 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11502 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11503 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11504 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011505
11506 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11507
11508 Example :
11509 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11510 backend https
11511 mode tcp
11512 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011513 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011514 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011515
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011516 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11517 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11518
11519 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11520 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11521 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11522
11523 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11524 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011525
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011526 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11527 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11528 # at offset 44.
11529
11530 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11531 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11532
11533 # Learn on response if server hello.
11534 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011535
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011536 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11537 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11538
11539 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11540 extraction.
11541
11542
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011543tcp-check comment <string>
11544 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11545 it fails.
11546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11547 yes | no | yes | yes
11548
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011549 Arguments :
11550 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11551 rule fails.
11552
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011553 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11554 user-friendly error reporting.
11555
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011556 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11557 "tcp-check expect".
11558
11559
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011560tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11561 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011562 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011563 Opens a new connection
11564 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011565 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011566
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011567 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011568 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11569
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011570 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011571 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011572
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011573 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011574 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11575 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011576 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011577
11578 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011579
11580 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11581
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011582 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11583
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011584 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11585
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011586 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11587
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011588 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11589 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11590 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11591 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11592
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011593 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11594 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11595 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11596 haproxy -vv.
11597
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011598 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011599
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011600 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11601 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11602 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11603
11604 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11605 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11606 of the sequence.
11607
11608 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11609 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11610 do.
11611
11612 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11613 unset-var or comment rules.
11614
11615 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011616 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11617 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11618 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11619 option tcp-check
11620 tcp-check connect
11621 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11622 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11623 tcp-check send \r\n
11624 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11625 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11626 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11627 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11628 tcp-check send \r\n
11629 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11630 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11631
11632 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11633 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011634 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011635 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11636 tcp-check connect port 143
11637 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11638 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11639
11640 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11641
11642
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011643tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011644 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011645 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011646 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011647 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011648 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011649 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011650
11651 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011652 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11653
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011654 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11655 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11656 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11657 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11658 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11659 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11660 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11661 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11662 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11663 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11664
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011665 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011666 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11667 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011668 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11669 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11670 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11671
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011672 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11673 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11674 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011675 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11676 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011677 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11678 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011679 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11680 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011681 By default "L7OK" is used.
11682
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011683 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11684 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011685 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11686 supported :
11687 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11688 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011689 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11690 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11691 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11692 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11693 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011694
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011695 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011696 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011697 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11698 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11699 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11700 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011701 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11702
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011703 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11704 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11705 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11706 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11707
11708 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11709 informational message reported in logs if an error
11710 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11711 log-format string.
11712
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011713 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11714 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11715 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11716 followed by some converters.
11717
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011718 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11719 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11720 with the usual backslash ('\').
11721 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011722 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011723 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11724 used upper or lower case.
11725
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011726 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11727
11728 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11729 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11730 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11731 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11732 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11733 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11734 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11735 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11736
11737 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11738 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11739 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11740 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11741 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11742 expression.
11743
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011744 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11745 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11746 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11747 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11748 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11749 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11750
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011751 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11752 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11753 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11754 this exact hexadecimal string.
11755 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11756
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011757 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11758 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11759 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11760 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11761 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11762 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11763 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11764 size.
11765
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011766 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11767 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11768 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11769 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11770 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11771 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11772 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11773 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11774 in a binary string before matching the response's
11775 buffer.
11776
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011777 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011778 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011779 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11780 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11781 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11782 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11783 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11784 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11785 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11786 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11787 the null character.
11788
11789 Examples :
11790 # perform a POP check
11791 option tcp-check
11792 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11793
11794 # perform an IMAP check
11795 option tcp-check
11796 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11797
11798 # look for the redis master server
11799 option tcp-check
11800 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011801 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011802 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11803 tcp-check expect string role:master
11804 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11805 tcp-check expect string +OK
11806
11807
11808 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011809 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011810
11811
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011812tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11813tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11814 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11815 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011816 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011817 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011818
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011819 Arguments :
11820 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11821
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011822 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11823 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011824
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011825 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11826 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011827
11828 Examples :
11829 # look for the redis master server
11830 option tcp-check
11831 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11832 tcp-check expect string role:master
11833
11834 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011835 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011836
11837
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011838tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11839tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11840 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11841 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011843 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011844
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011845 Arguments :
11846 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011847
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011848 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11849 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011850
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011851 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11852 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11853 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011854
11855 Examples :
11856 # redis check in binary
11857 option tcp-check
11858 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11859 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11860
11861
11862 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011863 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011864
11865
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011866tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011867 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011868 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011869 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011870
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011871 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011872 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11873 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11874 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11875 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11876 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11877 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11878 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11879 and '-'.
11880
11881 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11882
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011883 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011884 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11885
11886
11887tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011888 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011889 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011890 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011891
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011892 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011893 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11894 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11895 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11896 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11897 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11898 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11899 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11900 and '-'.
11901
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011902 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011903 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11904
11905
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011906tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11907 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11909 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011910 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011911 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11912 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011913
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011914 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011915
11916 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11917 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011918 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11919 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11920 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11921 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11922 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11923 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011924
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011925 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11926 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11927 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11928 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011929
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011930 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011931 - accept :
11932 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11933 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11934 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011935
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011936 - reject :
11937 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11938 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11939 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11940 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11941 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11942 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11943 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11944 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11945 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11946 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11947 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011948 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011949
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011950 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11951 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11952 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11953 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11954 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11955 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11956 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11957 hosts.
11958
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011959 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11960 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11961 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11962 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11963 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11964 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11965 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11966 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11967
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011968 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11969 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11970 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11971 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11972 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11973 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11974 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11975 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11976 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011977 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11978 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011979
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011980 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011981 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011982 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11983 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11984 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011985 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011986 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011987 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11988 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11989 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11990 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11991 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11992 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11993 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011994
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011995 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011996 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011997 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011998 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011999 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12000 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12001 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012002
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012003 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12004 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12005 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12006 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012007
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012008 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12009 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12010 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12011 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12012 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012013 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12014 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12015 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12016 layer7 information is extracted.
12017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012018 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12019 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12020 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12021 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12022 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012023
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012024 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12025 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12026 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12027 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12028
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012029 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12030 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12031 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12032 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12033
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012034 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12035 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12036 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12037 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12038 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012039
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012040 - set-src <expr> :
12041 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12042 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12043 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012044 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012046 Arguments:
12047 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12048 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012049
12050 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012051 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12052
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012053 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12054 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012055
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012056 - set-src-port <expr> :
12057 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12058 expression.
12059
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012060 Arguments:
12061 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12062 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012063
12064 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012065 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12066
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012067 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12068 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12069 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012070
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012071 - set-dst <expr> :
12072 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12073 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12074 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12075 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12076 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12077
12078 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12079 followed by some converters.
12080
12081 Example:
12082
12083 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12084 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12085
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012086 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12087 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12088
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012089 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12090 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12091 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12092 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12093
12094
12095 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12096 followed by some converters.
12097
12098 Example:
12099
12100 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12101
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012102 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12103 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12104 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12105
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012106 - "silent-drop" :
12107 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012108 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012109 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12110 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12111 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12112 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12113 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012114 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12115 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012116 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12117 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012118 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012119 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12120 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12121 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12122 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12123
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012124 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12125 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12126 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012127
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012128 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12129 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12130 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012131
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012132 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012133 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012134 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012135
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012136 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12137 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12138 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012139
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012140 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012141 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12142 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012143
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012144 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12145
12146 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12147
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012148 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12149
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012150 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012151
12152
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012153tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12154 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012156 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012157 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012158 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12159 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012160
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012161 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012162
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012163 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012164 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12165 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012166 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12167 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012168
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012169 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12170 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12171 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12172 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012173 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012174 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012175 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12176 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12177 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12178 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012179 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012180 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012181
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012182 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12183 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12184 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12185 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012186
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012187 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012188 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012189 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012190 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12191 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012192 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012193 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012194 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012195 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012196 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012197 - set-dst <expr>
12198 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet40f95c42021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012199 - set-src <expr>
12200 - set-src-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012201 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012202 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012203 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012204 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012205 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012206 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012207
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012208 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12209 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012210 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12211 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012212
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012213 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12214 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12215 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12216 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12217 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12218 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012219
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012220 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012221 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12222 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012223
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012224 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12225 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12226 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12227 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12228 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12229 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12230
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012231 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012232 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12233 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12234 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12235 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12236 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12237 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12238 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12239 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12240 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12241 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012242
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012243 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012244 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12245 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12246 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012247
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012248 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12249 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12250
Christopher Faulet40f95c42021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012251 The "set-src" and "set-src-port" are used to set respectively the source IP
12252 and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-src".
12253
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012254 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012255 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12256 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012257
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012258 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12259 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012260 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012261 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12262 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012263 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012264 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012265 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012266 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12267 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012268 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012269 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12270 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012271
12272 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12273 followed by some converters.
12274
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012275 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012276 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12277 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12278 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12279 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12280 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12281 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012282 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012283 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12284 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12285
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012286 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12287
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012288 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12289 <var-name>.
12290
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012291 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12292 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12293 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12294 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12295 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12296
12297 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12298 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12299 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12300 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12301 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12302 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12303 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12304 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12305 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12306 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12307 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12308
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012309 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12310 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12311 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12312 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12313 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12314
12315 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12316
12317 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12318
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012319 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12320 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12321 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12322 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12323 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12324 evaluated.
12325
12326 Example:
12327 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12328
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012329 Example:
12330
12331 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012332 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012333
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012334 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012335 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012336 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012337 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12338 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012339 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012340 tcp-request content reject
12341
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012342 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12343 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12344 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12345 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12346 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12347 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12348 ...
12349 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12350
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012351 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012352 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12353 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12354 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012355 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012356
12357 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12358 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12359 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012360 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012361 tcp-request content reject
12362
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012363 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012364 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012365 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012366 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012367 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12368 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012369
12370 Example:
12371 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12372 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012373 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012374
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012375 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012376 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012377
12378 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012379 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012380 # protecting all our sites
12381 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012382 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12383 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012384 ...
12385 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12386
12387 backend http_dynamic
12388 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012389 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012390 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012391 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012392 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012393 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012394 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012395
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012396 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012397
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012398 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12399 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012400
12401
12402tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12403 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012405 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012406 Arguments :
12407 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12408 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12409 as explained at the top of this document.
12410
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012411 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012412 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12413 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12414 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12415 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12416
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012417 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12418 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12419 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12420 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12421
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012422 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012423 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012424 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012425 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012426 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012427 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12428 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12429 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012430
12431 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12432 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12433 it pass through unaffected.
12434
12435 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12436 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12437 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012438 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012439 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12440 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012441 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12442 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12443 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012444
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012445 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012446 "timeout client".
12447
12448
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012449tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12450 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12452 no | no | yes | yes
12453 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012454 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12455 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012456
12457 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12458
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012459 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012460 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12461 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012462 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12463 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012464
12465 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12466
12467 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12468 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12469 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12470 inserted.
12471
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012472 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012473 - accept :
12474 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12475 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12476 the rules evaluation.
12477
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012478 - close :
12479 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12480 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12481 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12482 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12483 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12484 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012485 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012486 protocols.
12487
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012488 - reject :
12489 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12490 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012491 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012492
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012493 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12494 Sets a variable.
12495
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012496 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12497 Unsets a variable.
12498
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012499 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12500 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12501 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12502 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12503
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012504 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12505 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12506 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12507 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12508
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012509 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12510 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12511 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12512 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12513 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012514
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012515 - "silent-drop" :
12516 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012517 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012518 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12519 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12520 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12521 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12522 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012523 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12524 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012525 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12526 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012527 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012528 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12529 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12530 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12531 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12532
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012533 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12534 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12535
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012536 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12537 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12538 for changing the default action to a reject.
12539
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012540 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12541 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12542 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12543 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012544 period.
12545
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012546 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12547 declared inline.
12548
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012549 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12550 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012551 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012552 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12553 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012554 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012555 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012556 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012557 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12558 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012559 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012560 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12561 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012562
12563 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12564 followed by some converters.
12565
12566 Example:
12567
12568 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12569
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012570 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12571 <var-name>.
12572
12573 Example:
12574
12575 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12576
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012577 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12578 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12579 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12580 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12581 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12582
12583 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12584
12585 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12586
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012587 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12588
12589 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12590
12591
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012592tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12593 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12595 no | yes | yes | no
12596 Arguments :
12597 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12598 below.
12599
12600 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12601
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012602 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012603 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12604 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12605 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12606 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12607 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12608 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12609 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012610 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012611 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12612 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12613 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12614 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12615 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12616 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12617 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12618 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12619 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12620 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12621 instead.
12622
12623 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12624 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12625 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12626 rules which may be inserted.
12627
12628 Several types of actions are supported :
12629 - accept : the request is accepted
12630 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12631 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12632 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012633 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012634 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012635 - set-dst <expr>
12636 - set-dst-port <expr>
12637 - set-src <expr>
12638 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012639 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012640 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012641 - silent-drop
12642
12643 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12644 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12645 sections for a complete description.
12646
12647 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12648 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12649 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12650
12651 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12652 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12653 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12654 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12655 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12656
12657 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12658 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12659
12660 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12661 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12662 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12663
12664 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12665 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12666 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12667
12668 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12669 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12670 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12671
12672 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12673 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12674 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12675
12676 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12677
12678 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12679
12680
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012681tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12682 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12684 no | no | yes | yes
12685 Arguments :
12686 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12687 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12688 as explained at the top of this document.
12689
12690 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12691
12692
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012693timeout check <timeout>
12694 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12695 established.
12696
12697 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12698 yes | no | yes | yes
12699 Arguments:
12700 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12701 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12702 as explained at the top of this document.
12703
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012704 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012705 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012706 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012707 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012708 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12709 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12710 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012711
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012712 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012713 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12714
12715 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12716 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012717 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012718
12719 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12720 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12721 forget about it.
12722
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012723 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12724 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012725
12726
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012727timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012728 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12730 yes | yes | yes | no
12731 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012732 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012733 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12734 as explained at the top of this document.
12735
12736 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12737 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12738 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012739 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12740 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12741 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12742 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012743 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12744 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12745 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012746 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012747 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012748 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12749 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012750 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12751 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012752
12753 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12754 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12755 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12756 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012757 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012758 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12759
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012760 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012761
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012762 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012763
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012764
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012765timeout client-fin <timeout>
12766 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12768 yes | yes | yes | no
12769 Arguments :
12770 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12771 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12772 as explained at the top of this document.
12773
12774 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12775 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12776 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12777 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12778 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12779 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12780 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012781 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12782 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12783 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012784
12785 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12786 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12787 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12788
12789 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12790
12791
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012792timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012793 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12795 yes | no | yes | yes
12796 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012797 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012798 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12799 as explained at the top of this document.
12800
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012801 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012802 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012803 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012804 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012805 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12806 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012807
12808 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12809 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12810 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12811 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012812 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012813 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12814
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012815 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012816
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012817
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012818timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12819 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12821 yes | yes | yes | yes
12822 Arguments :
12823 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12824 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12825 as explained at the top of this document.
12826
12827 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12828 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12829 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12830 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12831 once the request has started to present itself.
12832
12833 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12834 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12835 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12836 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12837 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12838
12839 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12840 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12841 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12842 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12843
12844 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12845 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012846 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012847 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12848 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012849 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012850
12851 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12852 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12853 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12854 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12855
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012856 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12857 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012858 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12859
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012860 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12861
12862
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012863timeout http-request <timeout>
12864 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012866 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012867 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012868 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012869 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12870 as explained at the top of this document.
12871
12872 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12873 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12874 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12875 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12876 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12877 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12878 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012879 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12880 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12881 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12882 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012883 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012884 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12885 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012886
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012887 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12888 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12889 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12890 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12891 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012892 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012893
12894 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12895 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012896 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012897 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12898 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12899
12900 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012901 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12902 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12903 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012904
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012905 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012906 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012907
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012908
12909timeout queue <timeout>
12910 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12912 yes | no | yes | yes
12913 Arguments :
12914 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12915 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12916 as explained at the top of this document.
12917
12918 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12919 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12920 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12921 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12922 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12923
12924 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12925 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12926 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12927 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12928
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012929 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012930
12931
12932timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012933 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12935 yes | no | yes | yes
12936 Arguments :
12937 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12938 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12939 as explained at the top of this document.
12940
12941 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12942 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12943 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12944 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12945 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12946 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12947 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12948
12949 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12950 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12951 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12952 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12953 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012954 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012955 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012956 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12957 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012958 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12959 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012960
12961 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12962 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12963 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12964 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012965 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012966 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12967
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012968 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012969
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012970
12971timeout server-fin <timeout>
12972 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12974 yes | no | yes | yes
12975 Arguments :
12976 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12977 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12978 as explained at the top of this document.
12979
12980 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12981 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12982 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12983 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12984 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12985 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12986 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12987 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12988 situations, it should not be needed.
12989
12990 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12991 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12992 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12993
12994 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12995
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012996
12997timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012998 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13000 yes | yes | yes | yes
13001 Arguments :
13002 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13003 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13004 as explained at the top of this document.
13005
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013006 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13007 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13008 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013009
13010 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13011 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13012 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13013 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013014 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013015
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013016 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013017
13018
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013019timeout tunnel <timeout>
13020 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13022 yes | no | yes | yes
13023 Arguments :
13024 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13025 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13026 as explained at the top of this document.
13027
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013028 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013029 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13030 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13031 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013032 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13033 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013034 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13035 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13036 specified.
13037
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013038 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13039 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13040 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13041 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13042 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13043 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13044 state.
13045
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013046 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13047 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13048 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13049 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013050 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013051
13052 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13053 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13054 forget about it.
13055
13056 Example :
13057 defaults http
13058 option http-server-close
13059 timeout connect 5s
13060 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013061 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013062 timeout server 30s
13063 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13064
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013065 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013066
13067
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013068transparent (deprecated)
13069 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013071 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013072 Arguments : none
13073
13074 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13075 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13076 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13077 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13078 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13079 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13080 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13081 appropriate server.
13082
13083 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13084
13085 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13086 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13087
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013088 See also: "option transparent"
13089
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013090unique-id-format <string>
13091 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13093 yes | yes | yes | no
13094 Arguments :
13095 <string> is a log-format string.
13096
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013097 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13098 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13099 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13100 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013101
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013102 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013103 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013104 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13105 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13106 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13107 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13108 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13109 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013110
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013111 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13112 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013113
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013114 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013115
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013116 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013117
13118 will generate:
13119
13120 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13121
13122 See also: "unique-id-header"
13123
13124unique-id-header <name>
13125 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13127 yes | yes | yes | no
13128 Arguments :
13129 <name> is the name of the header.
13130
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013131 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13132 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013133
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013134 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013135
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013136 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013137 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13138
13139 will generate:
13140
13141 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13142
13143 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013144
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013145use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013146 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13148 no | yes | yes | no
13149 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013150 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13151 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013152
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013153 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13154 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013155
13156 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13157 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13158 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013159 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013160 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013161 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13162 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013163
13164 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13165 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13166 assign the backend.
13167
13168 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13169 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13170 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13171 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13172 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13173 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13174
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013175 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013176 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013177 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13178 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13179 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13180
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013181 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13182 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13183 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13184 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13185 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13186 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13187 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13188 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13189 cannot be forced from the request.
13190
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013191 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013192 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13193 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13194
13195 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13196 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013197
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013198use-fcgi-app <name>
13199 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13201 no | no | yes | yes
13202 Arguments :
13203 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13204
13205 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013206
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013207use-server <server> if <condition>
13208use-server <server> unless <condition>
13209 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13211 no | no | yes | yes
13212 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013213 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13214 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013215
13216 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13217
13218 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13219 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13220 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13221
13222 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13223 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13224 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13225 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13226 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13227 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13228 matches will assign the server.
13229
13230 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13231 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13232 with the next rules until one matches.
13233
13234 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13235 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13236 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13237 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13238
13239 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13240 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13241 stripped.
13242
13243 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13244 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013245 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013246 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013247 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013248
13249 Example :
13250 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013251 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013252 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013253 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013254 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013255 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013256 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013257 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13258 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13259
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013260 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13261 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13262 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13263 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013264 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013265 and we fall back to load balancing.
13266
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013267 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013268
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013269
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132705. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013271--------------------------
13272
13273The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13274depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13275settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13276written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13277described in this section.
13278
13279
132805.1. Bind options
13281-----------------
13282
13283The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13284as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13285no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13286parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13287while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13288provided immediately after the setting name.
13289
13290The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13291
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013292accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13293 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13294 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13295 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13296 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13297 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13298 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13299 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13300 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13301 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013302 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13303 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13304 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013305
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013306accept-proxy
13307 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013308 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13309 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013310 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13311 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13312 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13313 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013314 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013315 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13316 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013317 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13318 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013319
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013320allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013321 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013322 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013323 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013324 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13325 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013326
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013327alpn <protocols>
13328 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13329 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13330 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013331 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013332 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013333 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13334 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13335 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13336 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13337 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13338 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13339 preference, like below :
13340
13341 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013342
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013343backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013344 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013345 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13346
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013347curves <curves>
13348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13349 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13350 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13351 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13352 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13353 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13354
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013355ecdhe <named curve>
13356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013357 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13358 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013359
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013360ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13362 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13363 client's certificate.
13364
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013365ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13367 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13368 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13369 error is ignored.
13370
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013371ca-sign-file <cafile>
13372 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13373 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13374 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13375 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13376 'generate-certificates' for details.
13377
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013378ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013379 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13380 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13381 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13382 'generate-certificates' for details.
13383
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013384ca-verify-file <cafile>
13385 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13386 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13387 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13388 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13389 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13390
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013391ciphers <ciphers>
13392 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13393 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013394 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013395 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013396 information and recommendations see e.g.
13397 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13398 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13399 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13400
13401ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13402 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13403 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13404 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13405 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013406 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13407 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013408
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013409crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013410 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13411 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013412 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13413 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013414
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013415crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013416 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13417 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13418 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13419 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13420 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013421 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13422 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013423
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013424 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13425 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13426
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013427 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13428 are loaded.
13429
13430 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013431 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13432 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13433 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13434 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13435 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13436 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13437 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013438 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013439
13440 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13441 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13442 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13443 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013444 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13445 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013446
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013447 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013448
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013449 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013450 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013451 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13452 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013453 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13454 clients).
13455
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013456 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013457 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13458 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13459 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13460 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13461 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13462 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13463 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13464 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13465 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13466 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13467 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13468 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13469
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013470 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013471 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13472 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13473 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13474 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13475
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013476 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13477 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13478 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13479 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013480
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013481 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13482 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13483 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013484
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013485crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013487 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013488 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013489 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013490
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013491crt-list <file>
13492 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013493 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13494 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013495
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013496 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13497
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013498 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13499 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13500 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13501 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13502 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013503
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013504 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013505 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13506 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13507 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13508 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13509 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013510 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13511 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13512 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013513
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013514 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13515 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13516 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013517
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013518 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13519
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013520 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013521 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013522 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13523 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13524 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13525 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13526 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13527 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013528
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013529 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013530 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013531 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013532 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013533 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013534 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013535
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013536defer-accept
13537 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13538 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13539 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013540 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013541 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13542 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13543 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13544 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13545 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13546 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13547 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13548
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013549expose-fd listeners
13550 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13551 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013552 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13553 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013554 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013555
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013556force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013557 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013558 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013559 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013560 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013561
13562force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013563 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013564 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013565 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013566
13567force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013568 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013569 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013570 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013571
13572force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013573 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013574 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013575 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013576
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013577force-tlsv13
13578 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13579 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013580 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013581
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013582generate-certificates
13583 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13584 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13585 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13586 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13587 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13588 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13589 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13590 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13591 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13592 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13593 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13594
13595 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13596 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013597 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013598 certificate is used many times.
13599
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013600gid <gid>
13601 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13602 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13603 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13604 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13605 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13606
13607group <group>
13608 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13609 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13610 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13611 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13612 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13613
13614id <id>
13615 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13616 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13617 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13618 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13619
13620interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013621 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13622 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13623 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13624 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13625 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13626 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013627 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13628 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13629 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13630 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13631 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13632 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013633
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013634level <level>
13635 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13636 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13637 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013638 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013639 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13640 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13641 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013642 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013643 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013644 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013645 all counters).
13646
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013647severity-output <format>
13648 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13649 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13650 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13651 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13652 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13653 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13654 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13655 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13656 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13657 rfc5424 convention.
13658
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013659maxconn <maxconn>
13660 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13661 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13662 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13663 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13664 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13665 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13666 eat all memory.
13667
13668mode <mode>
13669 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13670 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13671 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13672 UNIX sockets.
13673
13674mss <maxseg>
13675 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13676 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13677 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13678 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13679 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13680 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13681 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13682 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13683 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13684 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13685 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13686
13687name <name>
13688 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13689 page.
13690
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013691namespace <name>
13692 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13693 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13694 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13695 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13696
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013697nice <nice>
13698 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13699 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13700 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13701 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13702 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13703 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13704 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13705 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13706 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13707 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13708 one for an RDP socket.
13709
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013710no-ca-names
13711 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13712 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013713 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013714
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013715no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013716 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013717 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013718 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013719 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013720 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13721 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013722
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013723no-tls-tickets
13724 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13725 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13726 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013727 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13728 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013729 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13730 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13731 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013732
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013733no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013734 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013735 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013736 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013737 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013738 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13739 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013740
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013741no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013742 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013743 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013744 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013745 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013746 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13747 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013748
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013749no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013750 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013751 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013752 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013753 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013754 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13755 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013756
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013757no-tlsv13
13758 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13759 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13760 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13761 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013762 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13763 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013764
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013765npn <protocols>
13766 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13767 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13768 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013769 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013770 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013771 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13772 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13773 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13774 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13775 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013776
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013777prefer-client-ciphers
13778 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13779 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13780 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013781 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13782 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13783 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013784
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013785process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013786 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013787 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013788 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013789 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13790 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13791 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13792 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013793 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013794 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13795 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13796 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13797 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13798 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013799
13800 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13801
13802 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13803 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13804 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13805 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13806 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13807 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13808 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13809 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013810
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013811proto <name>
13812 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13813 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13814 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013815 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13816 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13817
13818 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13819 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13820 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13821 also reported (flag=HTX).
13822
13823 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13824 a bind line :
13825
13826 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13827 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13828 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13829
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013830 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013831 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013832 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013833 h2" on the bind line.
13834
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013835ssl
13836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013837 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013838 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13839 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013840 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13841 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013842
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013843ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13844 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013845 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13846 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13847 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013848 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13849
13850ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013851 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13852 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13853 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13854 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013855
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013856strict-sni
13857 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13858 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13859 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13860 See the "crt" option for more information.
13861
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013862tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013863 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013864 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013865 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013866 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013867 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13868 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13869 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13870 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13871 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13872 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13873 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13874
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013875tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013876 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013877 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13878 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13879 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13880 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13881 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13882 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13883 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013884 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13885 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13886 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013887
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013888tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13889 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013890 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13891 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13892 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13893 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13894 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13895 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13896 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13897 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13898 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13899 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013900 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13901 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13902
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013903transparent
13904 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13905 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13906 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13907 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13908 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13909 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13910 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13911 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13912 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13913 so check for support with your vendor.
13914
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013915v4v6
13916 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13917 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13918 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13919 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013920 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013921
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013922v6only
13923 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13924 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13925 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013926 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13927 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013928
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013929uid <uid>
13930 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13931 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13932 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13933 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13934 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13935
13936user <user>
13937 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13938 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13939 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13940 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13941 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13942
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013943verify [none|optional|required]
13944 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13945 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13946 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13947 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13948 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013949 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13950 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13951 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13952 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013953
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200139545.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013955------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013957The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13958which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13959arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13960settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13961after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13962Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13963address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013964
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013965 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013966 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013967
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013968Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13969keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013971The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013972
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013973addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013974 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013975 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13976 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13977 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13978 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13979 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013980
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013981agent-check
13982 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013983 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013984 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13985 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13986 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013987
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013988 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013989 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013990 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013991 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13992 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013993
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013994 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13995 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13996 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13997 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13998 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013999
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014000 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014001 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014002
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014003 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14004 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14005 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014006
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014007 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14008 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14009 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014010
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014011 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014012 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14013 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14014 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14015 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014016 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014017 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014018
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014019 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14020 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014021
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014022 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14023 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14024 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14025 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14026 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14027 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14028 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14029 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14030 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014031
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014032 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14033 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014034 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14035 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14036 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014037 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014038
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014039 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014040 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014041
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014042agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014043 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014044 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14045 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14046 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14047 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14048
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014049agent-inter <delay>
14050 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14051 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14052
14053 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14054 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14055 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14056 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14057 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14058 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14059 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14060 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14061 of backends use the same servers.
14062
14063 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14064
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014065agent-addr <addr>
14066 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14067
14068 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014069 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014070 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14071 hostname, it will be resolved.
14072
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014073agent-port <port>
14074 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14075
14076 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14077
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014078allow-0rtt
14079 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014080 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14081 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014082
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014083alpn <protocols>
14084 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14085 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14086 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014087 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014088 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14089 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14090 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14091 now obsolete NPN extension.
14092 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14093 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14094
14095 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014097backup
14098 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14099 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14100 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14101 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014102 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14103 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014104
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014105ca-file <cafile>
14106 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14107 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14108 server's certificate.
14109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014110check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014111 This option enables health checks on a server:
14112 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14113 considered available.
14114 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14115 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14116 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14117 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14118 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14119 set.
14120 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14121 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14122 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14123 exchanges succeed.
14124
14125 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14126 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14127 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14128 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14129 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014130 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014131 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14132
14133 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14134 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14135
14136 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14137 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14138
14139 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14140 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14141 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14142 available.
14143
14144 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14145 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14146 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14147
14148 Example:
14149 # simple tcp check
14150 backend foo
14151 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14152 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14153 backend foo
14154 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14155 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14156 backend foo
14157 option tcp-check
14158 tcp-check connect
14159 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014160
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014161check-send-proxy
14162 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14163 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14164 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14165 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14166 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14167 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14168 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14169
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014170check-alpn <protocols>
14171 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14172 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14173 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14174
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014175check-proto <name>
14176 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14177 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14178 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014179 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14180 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14181
14182 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14183 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14184 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14185 also reported (flag=HTX).
14186
14187 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14188 directive on a server line:
14189
14190 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14191 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14192 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14193 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14194
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014195 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014196 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14197 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14198
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014199check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014200 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014201 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14202 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014203
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014204check-ssl
14205 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14206 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14207 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14208 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014209 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014210 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14211 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014212 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014213 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14214 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014215
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014216check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014217 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014218 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14219 for normal traffic.
14220
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014221ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014222 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14223 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14224 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014225 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14226 information and recommendations see e.g.
14227 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14228 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14229 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014230
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014231ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14232 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14233 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14234 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14235 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014236 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14237 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14238 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014239
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014240cookie <value>
14241 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14242 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14243 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14244 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14245 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14246 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14247 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14248
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014249crl-file <crlfile>
14250 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14251 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14252 to verify server's certificate.
14253
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014254crt <cert>
14255 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14256 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14257 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14258 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14259 certificate request.
14260
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014261 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14262 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14263 option is set accordingly).
14264
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014265disabled
14266 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14267 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14268 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14269 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14270 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014271 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014272
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014273enabled
14274 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14275 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14276 default value.
14277 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14278 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014279
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014280error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014281 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14282 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14283 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014284
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014285 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014287fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014288 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14289 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14290 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14291
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014292force-sslv3
14293 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14294 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014295 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014296 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014297
14298force-tlsv10
14299 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014300 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014301 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014302
14303force-tlsv11
14304 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014305 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014306 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014307
14308force-tlsv12
14309 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014310 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014311 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014312
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014313force-tlsv13
14314 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14315 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014316 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014317
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014318id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014319 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14320 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14321 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014322
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014323init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14324 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14325 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014326 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014327 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14328 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14329 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14330 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14331 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14332 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14333 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14334 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14335 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014336 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014337 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14338 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14339 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14340 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14341 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14342 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014343 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014344
14345 Example:
14346 defaults
14347 # never fail on address resolution
14348 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14349
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014350inter <delay>
14351fastinter <delay>
14352downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014353 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14354 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14355 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14356 between checks depending on the server state :
14357
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014358 Server state | Interval used
14359 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14360 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14361 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14362 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14363 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14364 or yet unchecked. |
14365 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14366 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14367 | "inter" otherwise.
14368 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014370 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14371 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14372 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14373 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014374 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14375 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14376 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14377 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14378 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014379
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014380log-proto <logproto>
14381 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14382 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14383 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14384 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14385
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014386maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014387 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14388 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014389 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14390 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014391 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14392 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14393 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14394 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14395
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014396 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14397 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14398 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14399 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14400 than 50 concurrent requests.
14401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014402maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014403 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14404 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14405 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14406 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014407 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14408 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14409 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14410 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14411 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14412 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14413 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014414
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014415max-reuse <count>
14416 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14417 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14418 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14419 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14420 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14421 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14422 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14423 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014425minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014426 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14427 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14428 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14429 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14430 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14431 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014432 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014433 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014434
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014435namespace <name>
14436 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14437 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14438 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14439 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14440
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014441no-agent-check
14442 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14443 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14444 default value.
14445 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14446 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14447
14448no-backup
14449 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14450 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14451 default value.
14452 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14453 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14454
14455no-check
14456 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14457 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14458 default value.
14459 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14460 "default-server" "check" setting.
14461
14462no-check-ssl
14463 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14464 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14465 default value.
14466 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14467 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14468
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014469no-send-proxy
14470 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14471 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14472 default value.
14473 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14474 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14475
14476no-send-proxy-v2
14477 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14478 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14479 default value.
14480 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14481 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14482
14483no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14484 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14485 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14486 default value.
14487 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14488 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14489
14490no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14491 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14492 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14493 default value.
14494 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14495 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14496
14497no-ssl
14498 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14499 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14500 default value.
14501 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14502 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14503
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014504 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14505 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14506 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14507
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014508no-ssl-reuse
14509 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14510 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14511 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14512 and for paranoid users.
14513
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014514no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014515 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14516 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014517 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014518
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014519 Supported in default-server: No
14520
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014521no-tls-tickets
14522 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14523 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14524 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014525 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14526 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014527 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14528 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14529 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014530 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014531
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014532no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014533 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014534 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14535 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014536 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14537 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014538 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014539
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014540 Supported in default-server: No
14541
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014542no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014543 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014544 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14545 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014546 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14547 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014548 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014549
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014550 Supported in default-server: No
14551
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014552no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014553 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014554 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14555 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014556 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14557 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014558 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014559
14560 Supported in default-server: No
14561
14562no-tlsv13
14563 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14564 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14565 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14566 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14567 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014568 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014569
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014570 Supported in default-server: No
14571
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014572no-verifyhost
14573 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14574 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14575 default value.
14576 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14577 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014578
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014579no-tfo
14580 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14581 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14582 default value.
14583 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14584 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14585
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014586non-stick
14587 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14588 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14589 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14590
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014591npn <protocols>
14592 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14593 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14594 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014595 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014596 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14597 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14598 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14599
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014600observe <mode>
14601 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14602 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14603 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14604 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14605 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14606 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014607 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014608
14609 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014611on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014612 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14613 Currently, four modes are available:
14614 - fastinter: force fastinter
14615 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14616 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14617 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14618 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14619
14620 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14621
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014622on-marked-down <action>
14623 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14624 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014625 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14626 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14627 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14628 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14629 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14630 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14631 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14632 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014633
14634 Actions are disabled by default
14635
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014636on-marked-up <action>
14637 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14638 Currently one action is available:
14639 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14640 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14641 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14642 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014643 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14644 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014645 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14646 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14647
14648 Actions are disabled by default
14649
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014650pool-low-conn <max>
14651 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14652 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14653 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14654 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14655 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14656 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14657 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14658 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14659 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14660 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014661 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14662 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14663 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14664 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014665
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014666pool-max-conn <max>
14667 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14668 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14669 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14670 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14671 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14672 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14673
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014674pool-purge-delay <delay>
14675 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014676 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014677 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014679port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014680 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014681 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14682 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14683 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14684 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14685 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014686
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014687proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014688 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14689 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14690 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014691 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14692 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14693
14694 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14695 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14696 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14697 also reported (flag=HTX).
14698
14699 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14700 a server line :
14701
14702 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14703 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14704 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14705 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14706
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014707 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014708 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014710redir <prefix>
14711 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14712 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14713 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14714 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14715 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14716 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14717 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14718 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014719 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014720 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014721 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14722 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14723 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14724 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14725
14726 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14727
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014728rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014729 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14730 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14731 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14732
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014733resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14734 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14735 server.
14736
14737 Available options:
14738
14739 * allow-dup-ip
14740 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14741 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14742 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14743 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14744 For such case, simply enable this option.
14745 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14746
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014747 * ignore-weight
14748 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14749 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14750 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14751
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014752 * prevent-dup-ip
14753 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14754 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14755 same fqdn.
14756 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14757
14758 Example:
14759 backend b_myapp
14760 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14761 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14762 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14763
14764 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14765 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14766 it
14767 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14768 different address
14769
14770 Default value: not set
14771
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014772resolve-prefer <family>
14773 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14774 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14775 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14776 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14777
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014778 Default value: ipv6
14779
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014780 Example:
14781
14782 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014783
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014784resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014785 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014786 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014787 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014788 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14789 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014790 configured network, another address is selected.
14791
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014792 Example:
14793
14794 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014795
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014796resolvers <id>
14797 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14798 hostname.
14799
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014800 Example:
14801
14802 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014803
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014804 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014805
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014806send-proxy
14807 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14808 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14809 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14810 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014811 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14812 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14813 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14814 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014815 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014816 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14817 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14818 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14819 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14820 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014821 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14822 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014823
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014824send-proxy-v2
14825 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14826 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14827 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14828 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014829 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14830 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14831 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14832 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014833
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014834proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014835 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14836 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14837
14838 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14839 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14840 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14841 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14842 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14843 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14844 connection is supported).
14845 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14846 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14847 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14848 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14849 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14850 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14851 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014852
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014853send-proxy-v2-ssl
14854 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14855 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14856 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14857 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14858 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14859 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14860 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014861 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14862 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014863
14864send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14865 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14866 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14867 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14868 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14869 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14870 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14871 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14872 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014873 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14874 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014875
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014876slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014877 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14878 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14879 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14880 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14881 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14882 parameters :
14883
14884 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14885 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14886
14887 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14888 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14889 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14890 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14891
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014892 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014893 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14894 seen as failed.
14895
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014896sni <expression>
14897 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14898 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14899 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14900 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014901 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14902 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014903 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014904 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14905 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014906
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014907source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014908source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014909source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014910 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14911 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14912 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14913 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14914
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014915 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14916 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14917 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14918 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14919 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14920 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14921 server.
14922
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014923 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14924 specifying the source address without port(s).
14925
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014926ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014927 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14928 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14929 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14930 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14931 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14932 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014933 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14934 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014935
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014936ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14937 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14938 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14939 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14940
14941ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14942 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14943 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14944 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14945
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014946ssl-reuse
14947 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14948 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14949 default value.
14950 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14951 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14952
14953stick
14954 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14955 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14956 default value.
14957 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14958 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014959
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014960socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014961 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014962 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14963 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14964
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014965tcp-ut <delay>
14966 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014967 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014968 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014969 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014970 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14971 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14972 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14973 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14974 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14975 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14976 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14977 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14978 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14979
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014980tfo
14981 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14982 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14983 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14984 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014985 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014986 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014988track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014989 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14990 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14991 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14992 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014993 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14994
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014995tls-tickets
14996 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14997 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14998 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014999 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15000 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15001 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015002 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015003 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015004
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015005verify [none|required]
15006 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015007 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015008 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15009 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015010 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015011 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15012 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15013 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15014 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15015 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15016 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15017 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15018 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015019
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015020verifyhost <hostname>
15021 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015022 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15023 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15024 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15025 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15026 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15027 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15028 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15029 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015030
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015031weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015032 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15033 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15034 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015035 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15036 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15037 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15038 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15039 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15040 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015041
15042
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150435.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15044-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015045
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015046HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15047using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015048configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015049This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15050can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15051workload.
15052This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15053resolution at run time.
15054Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15055carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15056
15057
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150585.3.1. Global overview
15059----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015060
15061As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15062different steps of the process life:
15063
15064 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15065 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15066 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15067
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015068 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15069 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015070
15071A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15072 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15073 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15074 resolution to know this new IP.
15075
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015076When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015077HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015078SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15079from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015080will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015081will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015082
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015083A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015084 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015085 first valid response.
15086
15087 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15088 servers return an error.
15089
15090
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150915.3.2. The resolvers section
15092----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015093
15094This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015095HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15096contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015097
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015098When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15099uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15100is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15101answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15102
15103When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015104used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015105
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015106 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15107 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15108 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015109
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015110 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15111 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015112
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015113 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15114 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15115 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015116
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015117For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15118following scenarios are possible:
15119
15120 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15121 ignored
15122
15123 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15124 applied
15125
15126 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15127 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15128
15129 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15130 retries the query with a new type
15131
15132 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15133 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015134
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015135As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015136a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015137<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015138
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015139
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015140resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015141 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015142
15143A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15144
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015145accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015146 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015147 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015148 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15149 by RFC 6891)
15150
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015151 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15152 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15153 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15154 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15155 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15156 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015157
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015158nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15159 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15160 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15161 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15162 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15163 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15164 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15165 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15166 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15167 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015168 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15169
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015170parse-resolv-conf
15171 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15172 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15173 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15174
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015175hold <status> <period>
15176 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15177 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015178 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015179 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015180 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15181 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15182 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15183
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015184 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015185
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015186resolve_retries <nb>
15187 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15188 giving up.
15189 Default value: 3
15190
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015191 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15192 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15193 type.
15194
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015195timeout <event> <time>
15196 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15197 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15198 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015199 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15200 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015201 Default value: 1s
15202 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015203 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015204 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015205 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15206 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15207
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015208 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015209
15210 resolvers mydns
15211 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15212 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015213 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015214 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015215 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015216 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015217 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015218 hold other 30s
15219 hold refused 30s
15220 hold nx 30s
15221 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015222 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015223 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015224
15225
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200152266. Cache
15227---------
15228
15229HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15230(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15231RAM.
15232
15233The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15234this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15235
15236If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15237independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15238when we try to allocate a new one.
15239
15240The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15241
15242It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15243"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15244for more details.
15245
15246When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15247replaced by "<CACHE>".
15248
15249
152506.1. Limitation
15251----------------
15252
15253The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15254
15255- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015256- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15257 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15258 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015259- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15260- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015261- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15262 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15263 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015264- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15265 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015266- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15267 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15268 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015269
15270- If the request is not a GET
15271- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15272- If the request contains an Authorization header
15273
15274
152756.2. Setup
15276-----------
15277
15278To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15279the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15280
15281
152826.2.1. Cache section
15283---------------------
15284
15285cache <name>
15286 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15287 size of cache is mandatory.
15288
15289total-max-size <megabytes>
15290 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15291 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15292
15293max-object-size <bytes>
15294 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15295 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15296 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15297
15298max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015299 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015300 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15301 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15302 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15303 default.
15304
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015305process-vary <on/off>
15306 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015307 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15308 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15309 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015310 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015311
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015312max-secondary-entries <number>
15313 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15314 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15315 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15316
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015317
153186.2.2. Proxy section
15319---------------------
15320
15321http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15322 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15323 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15324 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15325 after this one.
15326
15327http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15328 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15329 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15330 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15331 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15332
15333
15334Example:
15335
15336 backend bck1
15337 mode http
15338
15339 http-request cache-use foobar
15340 http-response cache-store foobar
15341 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15342
15343 cache foobar
15344 total-max-size 4
15345 max-age 240
15346
15347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153487. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15349----------------------------------
15350
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015351HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015352client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15353The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15354these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15355but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15356data called patterns.
15357
15358
153597.1. ACL basics
15360---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015361
15362The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15363content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15364from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15365simple :
15366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015367 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015368 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015369 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15370 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015372The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15373adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015374
15375In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015377 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015378
15379This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15380Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15381and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015382an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15383conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15384as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15385are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015386
15387ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15388'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15389which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15390
15391There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15392performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015394The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15395specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15396this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015397methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15398ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015399
15400Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15401 - boolean
15402 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15403 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15404 - string
15405 - data block
15406
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015407Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15408converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15409would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15410The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15411which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15412
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015413Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15414keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15415fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15416which are summarized in the table below :
15417
15418 +---------------------+-----------------+
15419 | Sample or converter | Default |
15420 | output type | matching method |
15421 +---------------------+-----------------+
15422 | boolean | bool |
15423 +---------------------+-----------------+
15424 | integer | int |
15425 +---------------------+-----------------+
15426 | ip | ip |
15427 +---------------------+-----------------+
15428 | string | str |
15429 +---------------------+-----------------+
15430 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15431 +---------------------+-----------------+
15432
15433Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15434matching method, see below.
15435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015436The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15437 - boolean
15438 - integer or integer range
15439 - IP address / network
15440 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15441 - regular expression
15442 - hex block
15443
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015444The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15445
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015446 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15447 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015448 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015449 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015450 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015451 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015452 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015454The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15455read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15456if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15457lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15458will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15459beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015460a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15462exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15463
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015464The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15465parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15466ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15467a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15468check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15469
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015470The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15471socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15472file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015474Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15475loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15476
15477 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15478
15479In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15480the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15481case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15482as well.
15483
15484The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15485sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15486do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15487methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15488is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015489obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015490followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15491default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15492that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15493string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15494
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015495The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15496By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15497string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15498resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015499server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015500waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015501flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15502function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015504There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15505sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15506be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015507
15508 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15509 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015510 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15511 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15512 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15513 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015514
15515 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15516 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015517 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015518
15519 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015521
15522 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015523 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015524
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015525 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015526 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15527
15528 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15529 binary or string samples.
15530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015531 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15532 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015534 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15535 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15536 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15539 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015541 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15542 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15545 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015547 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15548 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015549 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015551 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15552 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15553 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015554
15555For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15556request, it is possible to do :
15557
15558 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15559
15560In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15561buffer, one would use the following acl :
15562
15563 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15564
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015565On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15566possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15567
15568 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015570All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15571criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15572method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15573to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15574criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15575the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015577If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015578the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15579For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015581 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15582 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15583 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15584 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015585
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015586
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015587The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15588types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15589combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15590brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15591default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015593 +-------------------------------------------------+
15594 | Input sample type |
15595 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015596 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015597 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15598 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15599 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015600 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015601 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015602 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015603 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015604 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015606 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015608 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015609 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015610 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015611 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015612 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015614 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015615 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015616 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015617 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015618 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015620 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015621 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15622 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15623 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015624
15625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156267.1.1. Matching booleans
15627------------------------
15628
15629In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15630Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15631When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15632that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15633
15634Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15635return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15636"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15637
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156397.1.2. Matching integers
15640------------------------
15641
15642Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15643enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15644to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15645
15646Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15647matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15648lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015649
15650For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15651unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15652representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15653
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015654As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15655two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15656instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15657ranges and operators.
15658
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015659For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015660operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15661Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15662of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015663
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015664Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015665
15666 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15667 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15668 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15669 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15670 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15671
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015672For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015673
15674 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15675
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015676This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15677
15678 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15679
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156817.1.3. Matching strings
15682-----------------------
15683
15684String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15685different forms :
15686
15687 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015688 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015689
15690 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015691 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015692
15693 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15694 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15695
15696 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15697 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15698
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015699 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015700 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15701 matches.
15702
15703 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15704 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15705 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015706
15707String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15708exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15709characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15710string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15711to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015712before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015713
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015714Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15715(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15716Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15717
15718Example:
15719 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15720 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15721
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157237.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15724---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015725
15726Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15727they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15728possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15729passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15730the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015731the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15732match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015733
15734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157357.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15736-------------------------------------
15737
15738It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15739not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15740a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15741to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15742digits may be used upper or lower case.
15743
15744Example :
15745 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15746 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15747
15748
157497.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15750---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015751
15752IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15753netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15754within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015755host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015756difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15757at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15758does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15759parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015760
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015761The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15762abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15763
15764 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15765 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15766 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15767 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15768 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15769 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15770 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15771 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15772
15773Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15774192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15775
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015776IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15777Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15778trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15779IPv6 patterns.
15780
15781HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15782following situations :
15783 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15784 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15785 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15786 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15787 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15788 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15789 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15790 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15791 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15792 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015794
157957.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15796----------------------------------
15797
15798Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15799combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15800
15801 - AND (implicit)
15802 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15803 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015805A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015807 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015809Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15810indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015812For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15813"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15814requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15815is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15816
15817 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015818 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15819 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15820 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015821
15822To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15823and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15824
15825 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15826 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15827 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15828 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15829
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015830 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15832 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15833 use_backend www if host_www
15834
15835It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15836expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15837be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15838the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15839
15840 The following rule :
15841
15842 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015843 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015844
15845 Can also be written that way :
15846
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015847 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015848
15849It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15850to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15851simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15852sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15853good use is the following :
15854
15855 With named ACLs :
15856
15857 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15858 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15859 monitor fail if site_dead
15860
15861 With anonymous ACLs :
15862
15863 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15864
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015865See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15866keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867
15868
158697.3. Fetching samples
15870---------------------
15871
15872Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15873against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15874sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15875ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15876of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15877available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15878
15879This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15880Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15881compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15882deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15883
15884The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15885matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15886method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15887indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15888
15889As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15890when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15891mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15892the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15893ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15894
15895Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15896multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15897when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015898incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15899are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15901all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15902
15903Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15904 - name
15905 - name(arg1)
15906 - name(arg1,arg2)
15907
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015908
159097.3.1. Converters
15910-----------------
15911
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015912Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15913of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15914is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15915was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015916has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015917unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15918
15919These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15920sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15921the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015922support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015923
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015924A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15925support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15926supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15927(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15928bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015930The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015931
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001593251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15933 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15934 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15935 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15936 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15937 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15938
15939 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015940 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15941 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015942 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15943 frontend http-in
15944 bind *:8081
15945 default_backend servers
15946 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15947 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15948
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015949add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015950 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015951 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015952 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15953 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015954 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015955 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15956 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15957 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15958 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015959 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015960 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015961
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015962aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15963 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15964 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15965 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15966 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15967 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15968 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15969
15970 Example:
15971 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15972 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15973
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015974and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015975 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015976 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015977 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15978 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015979 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015980 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15981 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15982 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15983 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015984 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015985 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015986
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015987b64dec
15988 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15989 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015990 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15991 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015992
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015993base64
15994 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015995 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015996 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15997 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015998
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015999bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016000 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016001 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016002 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016003 presence of a flag).
16004
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016005bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16006 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16007 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016008 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016009
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016010concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16011 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16012 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16013 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16014 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16015 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16016 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16017 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16018 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16019 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16020 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016021 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016022 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016023 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16024 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016025
16026 Example:
16027 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16028 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16029 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016030 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016031 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16032
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016033cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016034 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16035 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016036
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016037crc32([<avalanche>])
16038 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16039 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16040 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16041 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16042 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16043 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16044 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16045 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16046 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16047 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016048 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16049
16050crc32c([<avalanche>])
16051 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16052 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16053 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16054 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16055 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16056 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16057 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16058 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016059
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016060cut_crlf
16061 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16062 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16063 updated.
16064
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016065da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016066 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16067 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16068 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16069 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016070 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016071 configuration language.
16072
16073 Example:
16074 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016075 bind *:8881
16076 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016077 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016078
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016079debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16080 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16081 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16082 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16083 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16084 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16085 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16086 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16087 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16088 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16089 printable sample types.
16090
16091 Example:
16092 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016093
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016094digest(<algorithm>)
16095 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16096 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16097
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016098 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016099 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16100
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016101div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016102 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16103 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016104 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016105 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16106 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016107 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016108 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16109 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16110 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16111 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016112 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016113 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016114
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016115djb2([<avalanche>])
16116 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16117 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16118 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16119 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16120 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16121 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16122 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016123 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16124 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016125
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016126even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016127 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016128 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16129
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016130field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16131 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16132 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16133 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16134 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16135 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16136 fields.
16137
16138 Example :
16139 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16140 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16141 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16142 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16143 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016144
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016145fix_is_valid
16146 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16147 Information eXchange):
16148
16149 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16150 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016151 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016152 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016153 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016154 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16155 checksum
16156
16157 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16158 the server can be parsed.
16159
16160 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16161 message, false if not.
16162
16163 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16164
16165 Example:
16166 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16167 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16168
16169fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16170 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16171 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16172 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16173 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016174 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016175 added.
16176
16177 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16178 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16179 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16180 fix_is_valid converter.
16181
16182 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16183
16184 Example:
16185 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16186 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16187 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16188 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16189 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16190
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016191hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016192 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016193 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016194 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016195 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016196
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016197hex2i
16198 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016199 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016200
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016201htonl
16202 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16203 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16204 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16205 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16206
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016207hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016208 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16209 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16210 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16211 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16212
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016213 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016214 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16215
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016216http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016217 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16218 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016219 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16220 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16221 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16222 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16223 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16224 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16225 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16226 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016227
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016228iif(<true>,<false>)
16229 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16230 string otherwise.
16231
16232 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016233 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016234
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016235in_table(<table>)
16236 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16237 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16238 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016239 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016240 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16241
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016242ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016243 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016244 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016245 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16246 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16247 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16248 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16249 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016250
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016251json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016252 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016253 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016254 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016255 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16256 of errors:
16257 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16258 bytes, ...)
16259 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16260 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16261
16262 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16263 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16264 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16265 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16266 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16267 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016268 - "ascii" : never fails;
16269 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16270 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016271 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016272 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016273 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16274 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16275
16276 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016277 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016278
16279 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016280 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016281 capture request header user-agent len 150
16282 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016283
16284 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16285 GET / HTTP/1.0
16286 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16287
16288 Output log:
16289 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16290
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016291json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16292 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16293 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16294 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16295 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16296
16297 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16298 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16299
16300 Example:
16301 # get a integer value from the request body
16302 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16303 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16304
16305 # get a key with '.' in the name
16306 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16307 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16308
16309 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16310 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16311
16312 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16313 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16314
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016315language(<value>[,<default>])
16316 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16317 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16318 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16319 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16320 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16321 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16322 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16323 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16324 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016325 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016326 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16327 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016328
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016329 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016330
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016331 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16332 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016333
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016334 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16335 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16336 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16337 use_backend spanish if es
16338 use_backend french if fr
16339 use_backend english if en
16340 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016341
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016342length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016343 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16344 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16345 type. The result is of type integer.
16346
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016347lower
16348 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16349 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16350 type. The result is of type string.
16351
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016352ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16353 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16354 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16355 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16356 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16357 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16358 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16359
16360 Example :
16361
16362 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016363 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016364 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16365
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016366ltrim(<chars>)
16367 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16368 representation of the input sample.
16369
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016370map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16371map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16372map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16373 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16374 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16375 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16376 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16377 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16378 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16379 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16380 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016381
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016382 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16383 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16384 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016385
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016386 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016387 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016388
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016389 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16390 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16391 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16392 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016393 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16394 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016395 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16396 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16397 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16398 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16399 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16400 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16401 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16402 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016403 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16404 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16405 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016406 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16407 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16408 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16409 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16410 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016411
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016412 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16413 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16414 the corresponding match text.
16415
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016416 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16417 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16418 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16419 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16420 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016421
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016422 Example :
16423
16424 # this is a comment and is ignored
16425 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16426 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16427 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16428 | | | `---------- value
16429 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16430 | `---------------------------- key
16431 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16432
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016433mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016434 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16435 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016436 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016437 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016438 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016439 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16440 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16441 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16442 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016443 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016444 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016445
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016446mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016447 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16448 <packettype>.
16449 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16450 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16451 from.
16452 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16453 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16454 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16455
16456 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16457 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16458 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16459 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16460
16461 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16462 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16463 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16464 packets only):
16465 17: Session Expiry Interval
16466 33: Receive Maximum
16467 39: Maximum Packet Size
16468 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16469 25: Request Response Information
16470 23: Request Problem Information
16471 21: Authentication Method
16472 22: Authentication Data
16473 18: Will Delay Interval
16474 1: Payload Format Indicator
16475 2: Message Expiry Interval
16476 3: Content Type
16477 8: Response Topic
16478 9: Correlation Data
16479 Not supported yet:
16480 38: User Property
16481
16482 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16483 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16484 packets only):
16485 17: Session Expiry Interval
16486 33: Receive Maximum
16487 36: Maximum QoS
16488 37: Retain Available
16489 39: Maximum Packet Size
16490 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16491 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16492 31: Reason String
16493 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16494 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16495 42: Shared Subscription Available
16496 19: Server Keep Alive
16497 26: Response Information
16498 28: Server Reference
16499 21: Authentication Method
16500 22: Authentication Data
16501 Not supported yet:
16502 38: User Property
16503
16504 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16505 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16506 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16507 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16508
16509 Example:
16510
16511 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16512 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16513 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16514 if data_in_buffer
16515 # do the same as above
16516 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16517 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16518 if data_in_buffer
16519
16520mqtt_is_valid
16521 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16522
16523 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16524 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16525 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16526 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16527
16528 Example:
16529
16530 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016531 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016532
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016533mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016534 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016535 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16536 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016537 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016538 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016539 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016540 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16541 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16542 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16543 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016544 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016545 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016546
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016547nbsrv
16548 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16549 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16550 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16551 map lookup.
16552
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016553neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016554 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16555 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16556 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16557 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016558
16559not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016560 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016561 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016562 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016563 absence of a flag).
16564
16565odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016566 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016567 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16568
16569or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016570 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016571 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016572 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16573 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016574 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016575 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16576 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16577 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16578 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016579 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016580 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016581
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016582protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16583 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16584 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16585 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16586 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16587 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16588 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16589 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16590 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16591 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16592 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16593 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16594
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016595regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016596 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16597 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16598 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16599 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16600 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16601 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16602 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16603 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16604 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016605 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16606 of characters with other ones.
16607
16608 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16609 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16610 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16611 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16612 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16613 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016614
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016615 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016616
16617 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16618 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16619 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016620 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016621
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016622 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16623 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16624
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016625 # capture groups and backreferences
16626 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016627 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016628 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16629
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016630capture-req(<id>)
16631 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16632 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16633
16634 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016635 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16636 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016637
16638capture-res(<id>)
16639 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16640 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16641
16642 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016643 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16644 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016645
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016646rtrim(<chars>)
16647 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16648 of the input sample.
16649
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016650sdbm([<avalanche>])
16651 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16652 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16653 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16654 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16655 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16656 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16657 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016658 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16659 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016660
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016661secure_memcmp(<var>)
16662 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16663 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16664 match.
16665
16666 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16667 performed in constant time.
16668
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016669 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016670 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16671
16672 Example :
16673
16674 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16675 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16676 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16677 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16678
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016679set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016680 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16681 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16682 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016683 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016684 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16685 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016686 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016687 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16688 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016689 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016690 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016691
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016692sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016693 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016694 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16695
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016696sha2([<bits>])
16697 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16698 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16699
16700 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16701 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16702
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016703 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016704 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16705
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016706srv_queue
16707 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16708 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16709 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16710 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16711 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16712
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016713strcmp(<var>)
16714 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16715 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16716 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16717 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16718 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16719 shorter).
16720
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016721 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16722 strings in constant time.
16723
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016724 Example :
16725
16726 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16727 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16728 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16729
16730
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016731sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016732 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16733 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016734 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016735 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16736 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016737 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016738 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16739 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016740 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016741 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16742 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016743 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016744 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016745
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016746table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16747 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16748 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16749 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16750 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16751 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16752 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16753
16754
16755table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16756 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16757 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16758 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16759 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16760 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16761 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16762
16763table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16764 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16765 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016766 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016767 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16768 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16769
16770table_conn_cur(<table>)
16771 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16772 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16773 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16774 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16775 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16776
16777table_conn_rate(<table>)
16778 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16779 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16780 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16781 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16782 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16783
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016784table_gpt0(<table>)
16785 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16786 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16787 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16788 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16789 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16790
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016791table_gpc0(<table>)
16792 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16793 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16794 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16795 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16796 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16797
16798table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16799 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16800 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16801 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16802 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16803 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16804 sample fetch keyword.
16805
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016806table_gpc1(<table>)
16807 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16808 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16809 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16810 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16811 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16812
16813table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16814 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16815 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16816 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16817 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16818 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16819 sample fetch keyword.
16820
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016821table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16822 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16823 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016824 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016825 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16826 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16827
16828table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16829 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16830 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16831 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16832 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16833 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16834 keyword.
16835
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016836table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16837 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16838 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16839 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16840 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16841 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16842
16843table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16844 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16845 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16846 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16847 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16848 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16849 keyword.
16850
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016851table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16852 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16853 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016854 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016855 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16856 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16857
16858table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16859 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16860 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16861 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16862 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16863 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16864 keyword.
16865
16866table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16867 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16868 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016869 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016870 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16871 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16872 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16873 keyword.
16874
16875table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16876 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16877 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016878 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016879 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16880 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16881 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16882 keyword.
16883
16884table_server_id(<table>)
16885 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16886 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16887 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16888 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16889 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16890 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16891
16892table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16893 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16894 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016895 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016896 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16897 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16898 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16899 keyword.
16900
16901table_sess_rate(<table>)
16902 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16903 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16904 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16905 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16906 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16907 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16908 keyword.
16909
16910table_trackers(<table>)
16911 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16912 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16913 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16914 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16915 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16916 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16917 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16918 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16919 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16920 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16921
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016922ub64dec
16923 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16924 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16925 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16926
16927 Example:
16928 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16929 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16930
16931ub64enc
16932 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16933
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016934upper
16935 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16936 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16937 type. The result is of type string.
16938
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016939url_dec([<in_form>])
16940 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16941 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16942 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16943 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16944 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16945 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016946
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016947url_enc([<enc_type>])
16948 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16949 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16950 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16951 optional argument is here for future changes.
16952
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016953ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016954 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016955 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16956 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16957 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016958 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16959 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16960 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16961 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016962 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016963 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16964 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016965
16966 Example:
16967 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16968 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16969
16970 message Point {
16971 int32 latitude = 1;
16972 int32 longitude = 2;
16973 }
16974
16975 message PPoint {
16976 Point point = 59;
16977 }
16978
16979 message Rectangle {
16980 // One corner of the rectangle.
16981 PPoint lo = 48;
16982 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16983 PPoint hi = 49;
16984 }
16985
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016986 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16987 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16988 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016989
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016990 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16991 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016992 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016993 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16994
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016995 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016996
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016997 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016998
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016999 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17000 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17001 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017002
17003 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17004 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17005 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17006
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017007 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17008 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17009 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017010
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017011
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017012unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017013 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17014 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17015 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17016 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17017 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17018 response),
17019 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17020 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17021 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17022 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17023
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017024utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17025 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17026 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17027 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17028 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17029 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17030 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17031
17032 Example :
17033
17034 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017035 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017036 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17037
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017038word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17039 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17040 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17041 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017042 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017043 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17044 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17045
17046 Example :
17047 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17048 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17049 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17050 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17051 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017052 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017053
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017054wt6([<avalanche>])
17055 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17056 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17057 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17058 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17059 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17060 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17061 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017062 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17063 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017064
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017065xor(<value>)
17066 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017067 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017068 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017069 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017070 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017071 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17072 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017073 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017074 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17075 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017076 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017077 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017078
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017079xxh3([<seed>])
17080 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17081 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17082 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17083 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17084 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17085 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17086 considered as cryptographically secure.
17087
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017088xxh32([<seed>])
17089 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17090 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17091 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17092 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17093 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17094 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17095 as cryptographically secure.
17096
17097xxh64([<seed>])
17098 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17099 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17100 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17101 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17102 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17103 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17104 as cryptographically secure.
17105
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017106
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200171077.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017108--------------------------------------------
17109
17110A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17111not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17112"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17113The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17114
17115always_false : boolean
17116 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17117 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17118
17119always_true : boolean
17120 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17121 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17122
17123avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017124 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017125 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17126 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17127 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17128 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17129 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17130 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17131 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17132 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17133 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17134 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17135 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17136 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17137 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017139be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017140 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17141 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17142 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17143 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017144 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17145
17146be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17147 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17148 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17149 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17150 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17151 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017152 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17153 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017154
17155 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17156 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17157 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017159be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17160 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17161 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17162 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017163 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017164 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17165 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017166
17167 Example :
17168 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17169 backend dynamic
17170 mode http
17171 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17172 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017173
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017174bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017175 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17176 of the string.
17177
17178bool(<bool>) : bool
17179 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17180 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017182connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17183 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017184 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017185 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17186 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017187
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017188 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017189 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017190 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17191
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017192 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17193 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017194
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017195 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017196 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017197 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017198 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017199 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017200 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017201 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017202
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017203 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17204 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017205 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017206 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017207
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017208cpu_calls : integer
17209 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17210 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17211 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17212 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17213 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17214 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17215
17216cpu_ns_avg : integer
17217 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17218 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17219 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17220 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17221 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17222 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17223 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17224 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17225 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17226 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17227 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17228
17229cpu_ns_tot : integer
17230 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17231 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17232 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17233 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17234 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17235 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17236 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17237 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17238 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17239 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17240 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17241 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17242 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17243
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017244date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017245 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017246
17247 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17248 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17249 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017250 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17251
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017252 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17253 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17254 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17255 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17256 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17257
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017258 Example :
17259
17260 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17261 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017262
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017263 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17264 # millisecond granularity
17265 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17266
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017267date_us : integer
17268 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17269 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17270 from the same timeval structure.
17271
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017272distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17273 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17274 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17275 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17276 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017277 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017278 list of supported tokens.
17279
17280distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17281 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17282 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17283 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17284 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017285 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017286 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17287 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17288 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17289 supported tokens.
17290
17291 Example :
17292 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17293 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17294 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17295 # send large files to the big farm
17296 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17297
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017298env(<name>) : string
17299 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17300 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17301 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17302 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17303 certain way.
17304
17305 Examples :
17306 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17307 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17308
17309 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17310 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017312fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17313 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017314 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17315 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017316 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17317 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017318 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017319 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17320 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017321
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017322fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17323 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17324 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17325 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017327fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17328 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17329 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17330 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17331 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17332 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17333 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17334 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17335 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017336
17337 Example :
17338 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17339 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17340 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17341 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17342 frontend mail
17343 bind :25
17344 mode tcp
17345 maxconn 100
17346 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17347 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17348 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17349 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017350
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017351hostname : string
17352 Returns the system hostname.
17353
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017354int(<integer>) : signed integer
17355 Returns a signed integer.
17356
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017357ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17358 Returns an ipv4.
17359
17360ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17361 Returns an ipv6.
17362
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017363lat_ns_avg : integer
17364 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17365 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17366 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17367 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17368 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17369 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17370 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17371 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17372 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017373 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17374 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17375 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17376 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17377 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17378 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017379
17380lat_ns_tot : integer
17381 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17382 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17383 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17384 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17385 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17386 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17387 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17388 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17389 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017390 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17391 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17392 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17393 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17394 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017395 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17396 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17397 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17398 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17399 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17400 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17401
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017402meth(<method>) : method
17403 Returns a method.
17404
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017405nbproc : integer
17406 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17407 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17408 and debugging purposes.
17409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017410nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17411 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17412 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17413 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017414 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17415 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17416 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017417
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017418prio_class : integer
17419 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17420 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17421 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17422
17423prio_offset : integer
17424 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17425 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17426 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17427 set-priority-offset".
17428
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017429proc : integer
17430 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17431 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17432 debugging purposes.
17433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017434queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017435 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17436 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17437 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017438 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17439 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17440 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17441 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17442 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17443
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017444rand([<range>]) : integer
17445 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17446 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17447 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17448 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17449 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017451srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17452 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17453 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17454 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17455 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17456 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017457 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17458 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17459
17460srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17461 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17462 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17463 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17464 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17465 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17466 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17467 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17468
17469 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17470 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017471
17472srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17473 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17474 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17475 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017476 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017477 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17478 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17479 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17480
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017481srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17482 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17483 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17484 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17485 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17486 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17487 fetch methods.
17488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017489srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17490 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17491 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017492 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017493 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17494 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017495 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017496 overloading servers).
17497
17498 Example :
17499 # Redirect to a separate back
17500 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17501 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17502 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17503
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017504srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017505 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17506 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17507 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17508
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017509srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017510 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17511 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17512 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17513
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017514srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017515 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17516 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17517 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17518
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017519stopping : boolean
17520 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17521 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17522 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17523
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017524str(<string>) : string
17525 Returns a string.
17526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017527table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17528 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17529 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17530
17531table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17532 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17533 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17534 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17535
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017536thread : integer
17537 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17538 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17539 and debugging purposes.
17540
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017541uuid([<version>]) : string
17542 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17543 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17544 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17545
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017546var(<var-name>) : undefined
17547 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017548 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17549 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017550 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017551 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17552 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017553 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017554 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17555 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017556 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017557 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017558
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175597.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017560----------------------------------
17561
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017562The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017563closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17564methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17565sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17566TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017567the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17568counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017569"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17570used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17571can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17572Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17573table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17574tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17575currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017576
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017577bc_dst : ip
17578 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17579 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17580 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17581 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17582
17583bc_dst_port : integer
17584 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017585 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017586
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017587bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017588 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17589 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17590 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17591
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017592bc_src : ip
17593 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017594 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017595 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17596 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17597
17598bc_src_port : integer
17599 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017600 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017602be_id : integer
17603 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017604 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17605 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017606
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017607be_name : string
17608 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017609 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17610 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017611
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017612be_server_timeout : integer
17613 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17614 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17615 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17616
17617be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17618 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17619 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17620 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17621
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017622cur_server_timeout : integer
17623 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17624 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17625 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17626
17627cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17628 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17629 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17630 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017632dst : ip
17633 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17634 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17635 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17636 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017637 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17638 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17639 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17640 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17641 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17642 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017643
17644dst_conn : integer
17645 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17646 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17647 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17648 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17649 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17650 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17651 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17652 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017653
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017654dst_is_local : boolean
17655 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17656 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17657 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17658 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017659 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017660 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17661 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17662 it only once per connection.
17663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017664dst_port : integer
17665 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17666 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17667 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17668 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17669 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17670 an HTTP header.
17671
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017672fc_http_major : integer
17673 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17674 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17675 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17676
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017677fc_pp_authority : string
17678 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17679 if any.
17680
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017681fc_pp_unique_id : string
17682 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17683 if any.
17684
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017685fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17686 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17687 header.
17688
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017689fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17690 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17691 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17692 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17693 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17694 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17695 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17696
17697fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17698 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17699 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17700 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17701 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17702 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17703 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17704
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017705fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017706 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17707 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17708 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17709 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17710
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017711fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017712 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17713 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17714 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17715 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17716
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017717fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017718 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17719 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17720 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17721 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17722
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017723fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017724 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17725 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17726 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17727 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17728
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017729fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017730 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17731 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17732 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17733 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17734
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017735fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017736 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17737 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17738 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17739 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17740
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017741fe_defbe : string
17742 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17743 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017745fe_id : integer
17746 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017747 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017748 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17749
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017750fe_name : string
17751 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17752 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17753 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17754
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017755fe_client_timeout : integer
17756 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17757 current frontend.
17758
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017759sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017760sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17761sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17762sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017763 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17764 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17765 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17766
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017767sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017768sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17769sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17770sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017771 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17772 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17773 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17774
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017775sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017776sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17777sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17778sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017779 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17780 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017781 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17782 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17783 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017784
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017785 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017786 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17787 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017788 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17789 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17790 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017791 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17792 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17793
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017794sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17795sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17796sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17797sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17798 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17799 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17800 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17801 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17802 when a first ACL was verified.
17803
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017804sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017805sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17806sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17807sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017808 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017809 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17810
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017811sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017812sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17813sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17814sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017815 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17816 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17817 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17818
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017819sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017820sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17821sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17822sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017823 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17824 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17825 See also src_conn_rate.
17826
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017827sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017828sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17829sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17830sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017831 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017832 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017833
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017834sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17835sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17836sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17837sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17838 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17839 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17840
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017841sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17842sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17843sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17844sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17845 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17846 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17847
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017848sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017849sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17850sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17851sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017852 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17853 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17854 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017855 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17856 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17857 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017858
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017859sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17860sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17861sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17862sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17863 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17864 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17865 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17866 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17867 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17868 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17869
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017870sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017871sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17872sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17873sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017874 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017875 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17876 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17877
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017878sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017879sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17880sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17881sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017882 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17883 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17884 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17885 src_http_err_rate.
17886
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017887sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17888sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17889sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17890sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17891 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17892 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17893 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17894
17895sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17896sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17897sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17898sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17899 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17900 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17901 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17902 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17903
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017904sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017905sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17906sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17907sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017908 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017909 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17910 src_http_req_cnt.
17911
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017912sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017913sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17914sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17915sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017916 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17917 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17918 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17919 src_http_req_rate.
17920
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017921sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017922sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17923sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17924sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017925 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017926 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17927 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17928 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17929 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017930
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017931 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017932 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17933 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017934 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17935
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017936sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17937sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17938sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17939sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17940 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17941 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17942 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17943 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17944 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17945
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017946sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017947sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17948sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17949sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017950 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17951 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17952 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017953
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017954sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017955sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17956sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17957sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017958 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17959 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17960 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017961
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017962sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017963sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17964sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17965sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017966 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017967 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17968 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17969 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017970 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017971 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17972
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017973sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017974sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17975sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17976sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017977 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17978 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17979 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17980 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17981 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017982 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017983
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017984sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017985sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17986sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17987sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017988 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17989 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17990 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17991
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017992sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017993sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17994sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17995sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017996 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17997 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017998 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017999 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18000 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018001 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18002 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18003 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018005so_id : integer
18006 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18007 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18008 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018009
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018010so_name : string
18011 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18012 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18013 strings instead of integers.
18014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018015src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018016 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018017 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18018 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18019 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018020 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18021 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18022 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018023 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18024 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18025 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18026 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18027 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18028 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18029 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018030
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018031 Example:
18032 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18033 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018035src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18036 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18037 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18038 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018039 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018041src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18042 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18043 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018044 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018045 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018047src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18048 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18049 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18050 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18051 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18052 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18053 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018054
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018055 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018056 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18057 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18058 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18059 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018060 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018061 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18062 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18063
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018064src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18065 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18066 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18067 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18068 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18069 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18070 was verified.
18071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018072src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018073 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018074 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018075 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018076 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018078src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018079 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018080 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18081 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018082 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018084src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18085 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18086 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18087 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018088 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018090src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018091 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018092 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018093 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018094 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018095
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018096src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18097 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18098 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18099 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18100 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18101
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018102src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18103 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18104 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18105 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18106 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018108src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018109 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018110 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018111 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18112 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018113 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18114 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18115 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018116
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018117src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18118 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18119 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18120 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18121 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18122 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18123 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18124 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018126src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018127 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018128 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018129 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018130 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018131 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018133src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18134 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18135 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18136 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18137 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018138 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018139
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018140src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18141 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18142 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018143 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018144 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18145 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18146
18147src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18148 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18149 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18150 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18151 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18152 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18153 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018155src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018156 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018157 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18158 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018159 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018161src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18162 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18163 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18164 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018165 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018166 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018168src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18169 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18170 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18171 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018172 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018173 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18174 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018175
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018176 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018177 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018178 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018179 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018180
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018181src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18182 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18183 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18184 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18185 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18186 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18187 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18188
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018189src_is_local : boolean
18190 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18191 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18192 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18193 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018194 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018195 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18196 once per connection.
18197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018198src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018199 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18200 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18201 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18202 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18203 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018205src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018206 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18207 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18208 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18209 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18210 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018212src_port : integer
18213 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18214 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18215 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18216 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018218src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018219 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018220 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18221 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18222 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018223 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018225src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18226 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18227 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18228 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18229 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018230 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018232src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18233 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18234 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18235 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18236 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18237 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18238 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18239 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18240 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018241
18242 Example :
18243 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18244 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18245 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18246 listen ssh
18247 bind :22
18248 mode tcp
18249 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018250 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018251 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018252 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018254srv_id : integer
18255 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18256 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018257 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018258
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018259srv_name : string
18260 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18261 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018262 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018263
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182647.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018265----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018266
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018267The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018268closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18269when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18270usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018271future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018272
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001827351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18274 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18275 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18276 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18277 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18278 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18279
18280 Example :
18281 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18282 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18283 # the request.
18284 frontend http-in
18285 bind *:8081
18286 default_backend servers
18287 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18288 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18289
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018290ssl_bc : boolean
18291 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18292 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018293 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18294 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018295
18296ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18297 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018298 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18299 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018300
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018301ssl_bc_alpn : string
18302 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18303 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018304 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018305 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18306 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18307 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18308 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18309 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018310 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18311 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018312
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018313ssl_bc_cipher : string
18314 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018315 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18316 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018317
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018318ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18319 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18320 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18321 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018322 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018323
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018324ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18325 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18326 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018327 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18328 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018329
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018330ssl_bc_npn : string
18331 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18332 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018333 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018334 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18335 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18336 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18337 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018338 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18339 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018340
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018341ssl_bc_protocol : string
18342 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018343 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18344 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018345
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018346ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018347 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018348 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018349 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18350 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018351
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018352ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18353 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18354 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18355 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018356 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018357
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018358ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18359 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18360 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018361 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18362 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018363
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018364ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18365 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18366 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18367 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018368 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018369
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018370ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18371 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018372 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18373 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018375ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18376 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18377 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18378 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18379 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18380 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018382ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18383 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18384 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18385 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18386 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018387
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018388ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018389 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18390 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18391 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018392 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018393 does not support resumed sessions.
18394
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018395ssl_c_der : binary
18396 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18397 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18398 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018400ssl_c_err : integer
18401 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18402 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18403 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18404 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18405 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018406
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018407ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018408 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18409 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18410 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18411 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18412 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18413 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18414 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18415 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018416 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18417 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18418 LDAP v3.
18419 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18420 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018422ssl_c_key_alg : string
18423 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18424 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18425 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018427ssl_c_notafter : string
18428 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18429 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18430 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018432ssl_c_notbefore : string
18433 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18434 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18435 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018436
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018437ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018438 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18439 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18440 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18441 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18442 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18443 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18444 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18445 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018446 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18447 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18448 LDAP v3.
18449 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18450 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018452ssl_c_serial : binary
18453 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18454 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18455 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018457ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18458 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18459 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18460 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018461 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18462 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18463
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018464 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018465 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018467ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18468 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18469 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18470 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018472ssl_c_used : boolean
18473 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18474 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018476ssl_c_verify : integer
18477 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18478 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18479 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18480 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018482ssl_c_version : integer
18483 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18484 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018485
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018486ssl_f_der : binary
18487 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18488 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18489 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18490
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018491ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018492 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18493 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18494 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18495 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018496 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018497 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18498 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18499 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018500 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18501 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18502 LDAP v3.
18503 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18504 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018506ssl_f_key_alg : string
18507 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18508 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18509 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018511ssl_f_notafter : string
18512 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18513 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18514 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018516ssl_f_notbefore : string
18517 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18518 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18519 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018520
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018521ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018522 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18523 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18524 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18525 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18526 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18527 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18528 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18529 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018530 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18531 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18532 LDAP v3.
18533 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18534 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018536ssl_f_serial : binary
18537 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18538 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18539 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018540
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018541ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18542 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18543 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18544 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018546ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18547 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18548 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18549 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018551ssl_f_version : integer
18552 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18553 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18554
18555ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018556 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18557 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18558 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018560 Example :
18561 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18562 listen http-https
18563 bind :80
18564 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18565 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18566
18567ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18568 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18569 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18570
18571ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018572 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018573 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018574 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018575 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18576 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18577 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18578 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18579 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18580 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018582ssl_fc_cipher : string
18583 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18584 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018585
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018586ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18587 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18588 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018589 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018590
18591ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18592 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18593 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018594 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018595
18596ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18597 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18598 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18599 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018600 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018601 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018602
18603ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18604 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18605 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018606 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018607
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018608ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18609 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18610 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18611 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18612
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018613ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18614 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18615 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18616 transport layer.
18617 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18618 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18619 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18620 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18621
18622ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18623 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18624 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18625 transport layer.
18626 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18627 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18628 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18629 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18630
18631ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18632 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18633 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18634 transport layer.
18635 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18636 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18637 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18638 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18639
18640ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18641 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18642 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18643 transport layer.
18644 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18645 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18646 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18647 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18648
18649ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18650 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18651 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18652 transport layer.
18653 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18654 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18655 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18656 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018658ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018659 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18660 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018661 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18662 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18663 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18664 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018665
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018666ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18667 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18668 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18669 wait until the handshake happened.
18670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018671ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18672 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018673 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18674 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018675 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018676 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018677
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018678ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018679 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018680 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18681 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018683ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018684 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018685 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018686 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18687 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18688 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18689 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18690 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18691 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018693ssl_fc_protocol : string
18694 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18695 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018696
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018697ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018698 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018699 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18700 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018701
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018702ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18703 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18704 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18705 transport layer.
18706 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18707 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18708 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18709 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18710
18711ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18712 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18713 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18714 transport layer.
18715 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18716 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18717 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18718 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18719
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018720ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18721 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18722 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18723 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018725ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18726 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18727 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18728 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18729 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018730
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018731ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18732 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18733 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18734 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18735 BoringSSL.
18736
18737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018738ssl_fc_sni : string
18739 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18740 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018741 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018742 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18743 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18744
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018745 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018746 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018747 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018748 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018749 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018751 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018752 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18753 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018755ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18756 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18757 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018758
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018759ssl_s_der : binary
18760 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18761 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18762 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18763
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018764ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18765 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18766 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18767 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018768 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018769 does not support resumed sessions.
18770
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018771ssl_s_key_alg : string
18772 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18773 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18774 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18775
18776ssl_s_notafter : string
18777 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18778 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18779 transport layer.
18780
18781ssl_s_notbefore : string
18782 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18783 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18784 transport layer.
18785
18786ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18787 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18788 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18789 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18790 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18791 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18792 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018793 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18794 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018795 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18796 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18797 LDAP v3.
18798 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18799 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18800
18801ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18802 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18803 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18804 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18805 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18806 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18807 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018808 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18809 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018810 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18811 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18812 LDAP v3.
18813 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18814 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18815
18816ssl_s_serial : binary
18817 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18818 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18819 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18820
18821ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18822 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18823 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18824 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18825
18826ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18827 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18828 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18829 layer.
18830
18831ssl_s_version : integer
18832 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18833 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018834
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200188357.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018836------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018838Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18839sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18840only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18841For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18842be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18843can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18844sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18845for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18846content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018847
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018848Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18849 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018850 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018851 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18852 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18853 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18854 sample expression). So be careful.
18855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018856payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018857 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018858 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18859 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018861payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18862 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018863 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018864 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018866req.len : integer
18867req_len : integer (deprecated)
18868 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18869 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18870 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18871 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18872 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018873 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018874 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18875 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018877req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18878 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018879 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18880 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18881 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18882 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018884 ACL alternatives :
18885 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018887req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18888 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18889 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18890 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18891 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018893 ACL alternatives :
18894 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018896 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018898req.proto_http : boolean
18899req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18900 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18901 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18902 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18903 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18904 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18905 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18906 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018908 Example:
18909 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18910 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18911 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018912 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018914req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18915rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18916 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18917 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18918 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18919 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18920 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18921 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18922 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018924 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18925 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18926 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18927 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18928 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18929 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018931 ACL derivatives :
18932 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018934 Example :
18935 listen tse-farm
18936 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18937 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18938 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18939 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18940 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18941 persist rdp-cookie
18942 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18943 # This is only useful makes sense if
18944 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18945 stick-table type string size 204800
18946 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18947 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18948 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018950 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18951 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018953req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18954rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18955 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18956 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18957 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18958 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018960 ACL derivatives :
18961 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018962
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018963req.ssl_alpn : string
18964 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18965 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18966 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18967 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18968 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18969 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018970 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018971
18972 Examples :
18973 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18974 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18975 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018976 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018977 default_backend bk_default
18978
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018979req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18980 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18981 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018982 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18983 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18984 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18985 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18986 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018988req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18989req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18990 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18991 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18992 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18993 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18994 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18995 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18996 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018998req.ssl_sni : string
18999req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19000 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19001 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19002 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19003 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19004 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019005 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19006 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19007 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19008 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19009 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19010 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19011 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19012 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19013 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019015 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019016 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019018 Examples :
19019 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19020 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19021 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019022 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019023 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019024
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019025req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19026 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19027 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19028 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19029 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19030 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19031 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19032 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19033 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19034 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019036req.ssl_ver : integer
19037req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19038 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19039 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19040 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19041 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19042 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19043 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19044 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019045 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019046 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019048 ACL derivatives :
19049 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019050
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019051res.len : integer
19052 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19053 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19054 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19055 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19056 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019057 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019058 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019059 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019061res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19062 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019063 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019064 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019065 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019066 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019068res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19069 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19070 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19071 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019072 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19073 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019075 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019076
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019077res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19078rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19079 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19080 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19081 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19082 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19083 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19084 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19085 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019087wait_end : boolean
19088 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19089 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019090 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019091 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19092 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019093 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019094 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19095 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019097 Examples :
19098 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19099 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19100 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019102 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19103 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19104 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19105 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19106 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19107 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19108 tcp-request content reject
19109
19110
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200191117.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019112--------------------------------------
19113
19114It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19115This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19116data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19117its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19118HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19119content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19120to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19121more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19122response are indexed.
19123
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019124Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19125 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19126 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19127 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19128 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19129 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19130 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019132base : string
19133 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19134 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19135 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19136 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19137 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19138 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19139 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19140 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19141
19142 ACL derivatives :
19143 base : exact string match
19144 base_beg : prefix match
19145 base_dir : subdir match
19146 base_dom : domain match
19147 base_end : suffix match
19148 base_len : length match
19149 base_reg : regex match
19150 base_sub : substring match
19151
19152base32 : integer
19153 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19154 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19155 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019156 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19157 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19158 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019159
19160base32+src : binary
19161 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19162 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19163 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19164 per-URL counters.
19165
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019166baseq : string
19167 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19168 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19169 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19170 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19171
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019172capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19173 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19174 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19175 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19176
19177capture.req.method : string
19178 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19179 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19180 because it's allocated.
19181
19182capture.req.uri : string
19183 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19184 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19185 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19186 allocated.
19187
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019188capture.req.ver : string
19189 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19190 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19191 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19192
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019193capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19194 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19195 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19196 The first entry is an index of 0.
19197 See also: "capture response header"
19198
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019199capture.res.ver : string
19200 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19201 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19202 persistent flag.
19203
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019204req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019205 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19206 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19207 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019208
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019209req.body_param([<name>) : string
19210 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19211 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19212 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19213 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19214 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19215 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19216 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19217 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19218 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19219 given.
19220
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019221req.body_len : integer
19222 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19223 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019224 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19225 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019226
19227req.body_size : integer
19228 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019229 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19230 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019232req.cook([<name>]) : string
19233cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19234 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19235 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19236 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19237 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19238 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19239 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19240 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19241 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19242
19243 ACL derivatives :
19244 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19245 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19246 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19247 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19248 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19249 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19250 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19251 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019253req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19254cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19255 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19256 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019258req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19259cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19260 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19261 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19262 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19263 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019265cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19266 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19267 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19268 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19269 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019270 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019271 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19272 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19273 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19274 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019276hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19277 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19278 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19279 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19280 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019281 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019283req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019284 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19285 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19286 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19287 with headers such as User-Agent.
19288
19289 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19290 found.
19291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019292 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19293 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19294 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019295 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019297req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19298 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19299 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019300 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19301 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019303req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019304 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19305 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19306 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19307 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19308 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19309 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19310 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19311
19312 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19313 found.
19314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019315 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19316 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19317 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019318 with -1 being the last one.
19319
19320 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19321 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019323 ACL derivatives :
19324 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19325 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19326 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19327 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19328 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19329 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19330 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19331 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19332
19333req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19334hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19335 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19336 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019337 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19338 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19339 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19340
19341 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19342 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19343 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19344
19345 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019346
19347req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19348hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19349 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19350 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19351 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019352 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19353 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19354 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19355 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19356 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019357
19358 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19359
19360 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019361
19362req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19363hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19364 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19365 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19366 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019367
19368 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19369
19370 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019371
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019372req.hdrs : string
19373 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19374 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19375 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19376 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19377
19378req.hdrs_bin : binary
19379 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19380 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19381 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19382 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19383 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19384 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19385
19386 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019387
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019388 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19389 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019391http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19392 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19393 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19394 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19395 basic auth is supported.
19396
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019397http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19398 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19399 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19400 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19401 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019402 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19403 basic auth is supported.
19404
19405 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019406 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19407 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19408 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19409 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019410
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019411http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019412 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19413 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19414 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019415
19416http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019417 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19418 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19419 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019420
19421http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019422 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19423 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19424 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019426http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019427 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19428 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019429 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19430 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019432method : integer + string
19433 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19434 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19435 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19436 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19437 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19438 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19439 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019441 ACL derivatives :
19442 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019444 Example :
19445 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19446 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19447 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019449path : string
19450 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19451 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19452 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19453 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19454 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019455 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019456 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019458 ACL derivatives :
19459 path : exact string match
19460 path_beg : prefix match
19461 path_dir : subdir match
19462 path_dom : domain match
19463 path_end : suffix match
19464 path_len : length match
19465 path_reg : regex match
19466 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019467
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019468pathq : string
19469 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19470 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19471 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19472 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19473 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19474 result in both cases.
19475
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019476query : string
19477 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19478 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19479 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19480 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019481 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019482 which stops before the question mark.
19483
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019484req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19485 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19486 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19487 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19488 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019490req.ver : string
19491req_ver : string (deprecated)
19492 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19493 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19494 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019496 ACL derivatives :
19497 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019498
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019499res.body : binary
19500 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19501 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019502 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19503
19504 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019505
19506res.body_len : integer
19507 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19508 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019509 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19510
19511 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019512
19513res.body_size : integer
19514 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19515 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19516 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19517 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019518 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19519
19520 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019521
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019522res.cache_hit : boolean
19523 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19524 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19525
19526res.cache_name : string
19527 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19528 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19529 empty string.
19530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019531res.comp : boolean
19532 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19533 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19534 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019536res.comp_algo : string
19537 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19538 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19539 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019541res.cook([<name>]) : string
19542scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19543 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19544 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019545 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19546
19547 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019549 ACL derivatives :
19550 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019552res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19553scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19554 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19555 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019556 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19557
19558 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019560res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19561scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19562 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19563 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019564 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19565
19566 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019568res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019569 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19570 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19571
19572 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19573 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19574
19575 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19576
19577 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019579res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019580 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19581 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19582
19583 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19584 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19585
19586 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019588res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19589shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019590 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19591 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19592
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019593 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019594 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19595
19596 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019598 ACL derivatives :
19599 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19600 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19601 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19602 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19603 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19604 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19605 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19606 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19607
19608res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19609shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019610 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19611 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19612
19613 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019614 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019615
19616 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019618res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19619shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019620 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19621 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19622
19623 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19624
19625 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019626
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019627res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19628 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19629 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19630 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019631 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19632
19633 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019635res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19636shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019637 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19638 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19639
19640 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19641
19642 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019643
19644res.hdrs : string
19645 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19646 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19647 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019648 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19649
19650 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019651
19652res.hdrs_bin : binary
19653 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19654 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19655 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19656 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19657 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19658 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19659 (length of 0 for both).
19660
19661 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19662
19663 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19664 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019666res.ver : string
19667resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19668 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019669 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19670
19671 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019673 ACL derivatives :
19674 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019676set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19677 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19678 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019679 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019680 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019682 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19683 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019685status : integer
19686 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19687 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019688 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19689
19690 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019691
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019692unique-id : string
19693 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19694 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19695 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19696 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19697 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19698 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019700url : string
19701 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19702 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19703 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19704 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19705 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19706 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19707 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019709 ACL derivatives :
19710 url : exact string match
19711 url_beg : prefix match
19712 url_dir : subdir match
19713 url_dom : domain match
19714 url_end : suffix match
19715 url_len : length match
19716 url_reg : regex match
19717 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019719url_ip : ip
19720 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19721 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19722 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19723 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19724 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19725 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19726 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019728url_port : integer
19729 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19730 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19731 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19732 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019733
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019734urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19735url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019736 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19737 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019738 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19739 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19740 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19741 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019742 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19743 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019744 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19745 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019747 ACL derivatives :
19748 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19749 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19750 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19751 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19752 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19753 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19754 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19755 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019756
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019758 Example :
19759 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19760 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19761 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19762 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019763
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019764urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019765 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19766 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19767 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019768
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019769url32 : integer
19770 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19771 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19772 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19773 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19774 is an unsigned integer.
19775
19776url32+src : binary
19777 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19778 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19779 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19780
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019781
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200197827.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019783---------------------------------------
19784
19785This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19786used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19787purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19788There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19789or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19790any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19791for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19792
19793internal.htx.data : integer
19794 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19795 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19796
19797internal.htx.free : integer
19798 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19799 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19800
19801internal.htx.free_data : integer
19802 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19803 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19804
19805internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019806 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19807 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19808 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019809
19810internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19811 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19812 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19813
19814internal.htx.size : integer
19815 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19816 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19817
19818internal.htx.used : integer
19819 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19820 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19821 direction.
19822
19823internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19824 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19825 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19826 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19827 of the special value :
19828 * head : The oldest inserted block
19829 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019830 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019831
19832internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19833 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19834 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19835 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19836 integer or one of the special value :
19837 * head : The oldest inserted block
19838 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019839 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019840
19841internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19842 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19843 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19844 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19845 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19846
19847 * head : The oldest inserted block
19848 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019849 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019850
19851internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19852 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19853 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19854 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19855 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19856
19857 * head : The oldest inserted block
19858 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019859 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019860
19861internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19862 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19863 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19864 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19865 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19866
19867 * head : The oldest inserted block
19868 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019869 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019870
19871internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19872 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19873 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19874 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19875 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19876
19877 * head : The oldest inserted block
19878 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019879 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019880
19881internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19882 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19883 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19884 it returns false.
19885
19886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200198877.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019888---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019890Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19891every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019892order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019894ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019895---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19896FALSE always_false never match
19897HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19898HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19899HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019900HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019901HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19902HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19903HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19904HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19905LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19906METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19907METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19908METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19909METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19910METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19911METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19912METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19913METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19914RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19915REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19916TRUE always_true always match
19917WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19918---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019919
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199218. Logging
19922----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019923
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019924One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19925provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19926very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19927provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19928state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019929to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019930headers.
19931
19932In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19933about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19934send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19935
19936 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19937 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19938 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19939 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19940 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019941 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019942 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019943
19944The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19945allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19946as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19947while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19948real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19949delay.
19950
19951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199528.1. Log levels
19953---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019954
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019955TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019956source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019957HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19958in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19959track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19960syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19961about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019962
19963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199648.2. Log formats
19965----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019966
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019967HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019968and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19969slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19970options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019971
19972 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19973 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19974 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19975 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19976 extents.
19977
19978 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19979 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19980 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19981 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19982 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19983
19984 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19985 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19986 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19987 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19988 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19989
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019990 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19991 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19992 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19993 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19994
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019995 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19996
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019997Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19998specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19999field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20000servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20001always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20002identifier.
20003
20004Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20005 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20006 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20007 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20008 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20009
20010
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200118.2.1. Default log format
20012-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020013
20014This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20015as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20016format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20017
20018 Example :
20019 listen www
20020 mode http
20021 log global
20022 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20023
20024 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20025 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20026 (www/HTTP)
20027
20028 Field Format Extract from the example above
20029 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20030 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20031 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20032 4 'to' to
20033 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20034 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20035
20036Detailed fields description :
20037 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20038 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20039 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20040 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20041 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20042 and processed the connection.
20043 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20044
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020045In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20046"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20047connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20048
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020049It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20050will eventually disappear.
20051
20052
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200538.2.2. TCP log format
20054---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020055
20056The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20057is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20058information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20059counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20060emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20061environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20062the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20063sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020064specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20065not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20066fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20067marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020068
20069 Example :
20070 frontend fnt
20071 mode tcp
20072 option tcplog
20073 log global
20074 default_backend bck
20075
20076 backend bck
20077 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20078
20079 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20080 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20081 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20082
20083 Field Format Extract from the example above
20084 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20085 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20086 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20087 4 frontend_name fnt
20088 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20089 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20090 7 bytes_read* 212
20091 8 termination_state --
20092 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20093 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20094
20095Detailed fields description :
20096 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020097 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020098 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20099 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020100 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020101 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020102 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020103
20104 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020105 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20106 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20107 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020108
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020109 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020110 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20111 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020112 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20113 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20114 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20115 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020116
20117 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20118 and processed the connection.
20119
20120 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20121 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20122 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20123 applications.
20124
20125 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20126 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20127 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20128 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20129 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20130
20131 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20132 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20133 See "Timers" below for more details.
20134
20135 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20136 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20137 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20138 "Timers" below for more details.
20139
20140 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020141 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020142 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20143 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20144 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20145 details.
20146
20147 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20148 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20149 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20150 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20151 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20152
20153 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20154 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20155 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20156 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20157 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20158 for more details.
20159
20160 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020161 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020162 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20163 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20164 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020165 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020166
20167 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20168 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20169 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20170 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20171 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20172 caused by a denial of service attack.
20173
20174 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20175 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20176 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20177 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20178 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20179 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20180 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20181 denial of service attack.
20182
20183 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20184 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20185 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20186 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20187 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20188 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20189 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20190 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20191 be processed than on other servers.
20192
20193 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20194 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20195 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20196 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020197 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020198 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20199 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20200 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20201 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20202 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20203 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20204 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20205 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20206
20207 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20208 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20209 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20210 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20211 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20212 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020213 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020214 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20215
20216 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20217 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20218 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20219 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20220 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20221 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020222 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020223 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20224 occurs.
20225
20226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202278.2.3. HTTP log format
20228----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020229
20230The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20231is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20232the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20233are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20234emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20235generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20236"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20237which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020238frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20239is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020240
20241Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20242slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20243with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20244
20245 Example :
20246 frontend http-in
20247 mode http
20248 option httplog
20249 log global
20250 default_backend bck
20251
20252 backend static
20253 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20254
20255 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20256 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20257 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020258 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020259
20260 Field Format Extract from the example above
20261 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20262 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020263 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020264 4 frontend_name http-in
20265 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020266 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020267 7 status_code 200
20268 8 bytes_read* 2750
20269 9 captured_request_cookie -
20270 10 captured_response_cookie -
20271 11 termination_state ----
20272 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20273 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20274 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20275 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20276 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020277
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020278Detailed fields description :
20279 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020280 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020281 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20282 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020283 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020284 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020285 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020286
20287 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020288 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20289 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20290 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020291
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020292 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020293 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020294
20295 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20296 and processed the connection.
20297
20298 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20299 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20300 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20301
20302 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20303 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20304 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20305 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20306 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20307 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20308
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020309 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20310 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20311 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020312 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020313 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20314 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020315 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020316 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020317
20318 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20319 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020320 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020321
20322 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20323 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020324 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20325 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020326
20327 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20328 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20329 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20330 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20331 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020332 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20333 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020334
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020335 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020336 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20337 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20338 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20339 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20340 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20341 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020342 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020343
20344 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020345 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20346 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020347
20348 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20349 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020350 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020351 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20352 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20353 overflowing.
20354
20355 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20356 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20357 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20358 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20359 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20360 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20361 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20362 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20363
20364 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20365 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20366 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20367 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20368 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20369 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20370 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20371 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20372
20373 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20374 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20375 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20376 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20377 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20378 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20379 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20380
20381 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020382 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020383 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20384 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20385 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020386 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020387 system.
20388
20389 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20390 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20391 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20392 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20393 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20394 caused by a denial of service attack.
20395
20396 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20397 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20398 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20399 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20400 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20401 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20402 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20403 denial of service attack.
20404
20405 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20406 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20407 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20408 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20409 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20410 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20411 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20412 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20413 processed than on other servers.
20414
20415 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20416 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20417 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20418 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020419 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020420 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20421 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20422 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20423 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20424 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20425 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20426 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20427 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20428
20429 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20430 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20431 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20432 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20433 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20434 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020435 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020436 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20437
20438 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20439 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20440 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20441 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20442 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20443 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020444 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020445 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20446 occurs.
20447
20448 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20449 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20450 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20451 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20452 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20453 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20454 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20455 cookies" below for more details.
20456
20457 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20458 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20459 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20460 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20461 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20462 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20463 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20464 and cookies" below for more details.
20465
20466 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20467 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20468 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20469 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20470 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20471 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20472 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20473 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20474
20475
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200204768.2.4. Custom log format
20477------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020478
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020479The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020480mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020481
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020482HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020483Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20484separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20485prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20486
20487Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20488variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020489("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020490
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020491If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020492as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020493less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20494the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20495
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020496Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20497"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20498delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20499preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020500
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020501Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20502'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20503https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20504such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20505
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020506Flags are :
20507 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020508 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020509 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20510 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020511
20512 Example:
20513
20514 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20515 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20516
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020517 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20518
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020519At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20520
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020521 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20522 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020523
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020524the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020525
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020526 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20527 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20528 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020529
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020530and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20531
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020532 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20533 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020534
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020535Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20536
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020537 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020538 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020539 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20540 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20541 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020542 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20543 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20544 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020545 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020546 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020547 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020548 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020549 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020550 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20551 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020552 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020553 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020554 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020555 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020556 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020557 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020558 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020559 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20560 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20561 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20562 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20563 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020564 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020565 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020566 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020567 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020568 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020569 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20570 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020571 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20572 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20573 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020574 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020575 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20576 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020577 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020578 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20579 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20580 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020581 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020582 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020583 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20584 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20585 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20586 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020587 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020588 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020589 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020590 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020591 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020592 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020593 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20594 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20595 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020596 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020597 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20598 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020599 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020600 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20601 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020602 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020603 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020604 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020605 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020606
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020607 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020608
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020609
206108.2.5. Error log format
20611-----------------------
20612
20613When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020614protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020615By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20616"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020617will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020618logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20619
20620The format looks like this :
20621
20622 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20623 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20624 Connection error during SSL handshake
20625
20626 Field Format Extract from the example above
20627 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20628 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20629 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20630 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20631 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20632
20633These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20634failures.
20635
20636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206378.3. Advanced logging options
20638-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020639
20640Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20641just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20642options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20643for more information about their usage.
20644
20645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206468.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20647------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020648
20649It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020650HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020651commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20652monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20653ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20654
20655 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20656 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20657 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20658 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20659
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020660 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20661 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020662
20663 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20664 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20665 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20666
20667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206688.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20669----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020670
20671The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20672what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20673or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020674"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020675just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20676log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20677after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20678is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20679with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20680with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20681
20682
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206838.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20684------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020685
20686Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20687for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20688"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20689retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20690raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20691a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20692file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20693you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20694"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20695
20696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206978.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20698--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020699
20700Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20701multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20702them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20703"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20704logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20705error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20706and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20707too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20708useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20709alternative.
20710
20711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207128.4. Timing events
20713------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020714
20715Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20716reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20717the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20718frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020719mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20720addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20721
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020722Timings events in HTTP mode:
20723
20724 first request 2nd request
20725 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20726 t tr t tr ...
20727 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20728 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20729 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20730 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020731 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020732 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20733
20734Timings events in TCP mode:
20735
20736 TCP session
20737 |<----------------->|
20738 t t
20739 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20740 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20741 |<------ Tt ------->|
20742
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020743 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020744 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020745 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20746 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20747 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020748 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020749 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20750 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20751 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20752 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020753
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020754 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20755 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20756 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020757 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20758 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20759 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20760 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20761 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20762 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020763
20764 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20765 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20766 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20767 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20768 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20769 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20770 request typed by hand during a test.
20771
20772 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20773 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020774 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020775 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20776 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20777 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20778 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020779
20780 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20781 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20782 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20783 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20784 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20785
20786 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20787 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20788 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20789 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20790 connection never established.
20791
20792 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20793 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20794 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20795 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20796 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20797 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20798 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20799 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20800 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20801 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20802 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20803
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020804 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20805 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20806 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20807 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20808 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20809 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20810
20811 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20812
20813 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20814 "Ta" can never be negative.
20815
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020816 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20817 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020818 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20819 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020820 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020821
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020822 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020823
20824 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020825 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20826 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020827
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020828 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20829 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20830 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20831 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20832 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20833 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20834 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20835 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20836
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020837These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20838protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20839that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020840due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20841"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20842that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020843
20844Most common cases :
20845
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020846 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20847 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20848 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20849 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20850 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020851 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020852 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20853 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20854 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20855 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20856 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020857 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020858
20859 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20860 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20861 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20862 of ms on remote networks.
20863
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020864 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20865 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20866 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020867
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020868 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20869 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020870 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020871 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20872 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20873 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20874 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20875 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20876 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020877
20878Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20879
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020880 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020881 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020882 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020883
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020884 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020885 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20886 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20887
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020888 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020889 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20890 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20891 flags.
20892
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020893 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20894 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020895 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20896 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20897 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20898 the client connection was maintained open.
20899
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020900 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020901 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020902 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020903 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20904
20905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209068.5. Session state at disconnection
20907-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020908
20909TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20910"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
209112-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20912each of which has a special meaning :
20913
20914 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20915 session to terminate :
20916
20917 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20918
20919 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20920 server explicitly refused it.
20921
20922 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20923 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20924 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20925 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020926 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020927
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020928 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020929 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020930
20931 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20932 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20933 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20934 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20935 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20936
20937 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20938 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20939 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20940 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20941 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20942
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020943 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020944 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20945
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020946 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020947 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20948 backup connections when going up.
20949
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020950 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020951
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020952 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20953 send or receive data.
20954
20955 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20956 send or receive data.
20957
20958 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20959 with nothing left in the buffers.
20960
20961 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20962
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020963 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020964 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20965
20966 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20967 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20968 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20969 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20970 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20971
20972 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20973 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20974
20975 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20976 server (HTTP only).
20977
20978 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20979
20980 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20981 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20982 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20983
20984 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20985 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20986 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20987
20988 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20989
20990 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20991 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20992
20993 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20994 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20995 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20996
20997 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20998 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020999 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21000 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021001
21002 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21003 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21004 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21005 another server.
21006
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021007 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021008 server.
21009
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021010 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21011 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21012 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21013 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21014
21015 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21016 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21017 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21018 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21019
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021020 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21021 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21022 "use-server" rule).
21023
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021024 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21025
21026 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21027 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21028
21029 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21030
21031 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21032 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21033 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21034
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021035 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21036 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021037 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021038 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21039 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21040
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021041 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21042
21043 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21044 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21045
21046 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21047
21048 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21049
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021050The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21051was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021052helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21053starvation, attacks, etc...
21054
21055The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21056alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21057easier finding and understanding.
21058
21059 Flags Reason
21060
21061 -- Normal termination.
21062
21063 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021064 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21065 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021066 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21067
21068 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21069 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021070 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21071 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021072 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21073 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021074
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021075 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21076 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021077 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021078
21079 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21080 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21081 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21082
21083 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21084 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21085 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21086 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21087 the server takes too long to respond.
21088
21089 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21090 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21091 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21092 long a time to respond.
21093
21094 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21095 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21096 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021097 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021098 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21099 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021100
21101 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21102 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21103 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21104 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21105 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021106 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021107 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21108 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21109 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21110 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21111 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21112 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21113 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21114 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021115 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021116 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21117 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21118 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021119
21120 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21121 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021122 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21123 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21124 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21125 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021126
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021127 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021128 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21129
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021130 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021131 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21132 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021133 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021134 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21135 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21136
21137 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21138 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21139 503 or 504 here.
21140
21141 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021142 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021143 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21144 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21145 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21146
21147 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21148 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021149 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021150 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021151 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021152
21153 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21154 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21155 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21156 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21157 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21158 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021159 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021160
21161 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21162 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21163 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21164 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21165 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21166 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21167 solution is to fix the application.
21168
21169 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21170 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21171 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21172 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21173 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21174 external attacks.
21175
21176 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021177 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021178 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021179 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21180 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21181
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021182 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21183 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21184 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021185 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021186 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021187
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021188 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21189 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21190 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21191 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021192 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21193 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21194 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21195 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21196 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021197
21198 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21199 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21200 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21201 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21202
21203 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21204 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21205 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21206 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21207
21208 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21209 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21210 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21211 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21212
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021213The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021214persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021215important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21216re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21217
21218 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21219
21220 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21221 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21222 set on a GET request.
21223
21224 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21225 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021226 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021227 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21228
21229 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21230 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21231 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21232
21233 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21234 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21235 already got a cookie.
21236
21237 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21238 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21239 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21240 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21241 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21242
21243 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21244 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21245 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21246
21247 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21248 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21249 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21250
21251 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21252 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21253
21254 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21255 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21256 then advertised in the response.
21257
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212598.6. Non-printable characters
21260-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021261
21262In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21263consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21264converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21265prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21266being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21267escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21268is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21269'}' when logging headers.
21270
21271Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21272issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21273containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21274
21275Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21276the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21277performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21278
21279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212808.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21281---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021282
21283Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21284achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021285section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021286cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21287the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21288the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021289locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021290not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21291user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21292a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21293wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21294
21295 Examples :
21296 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21297 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21298
21299 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21300 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21301
21302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21304---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021305
21306Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21307proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21308the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21309server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21310
21311Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21312response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021313section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021314
21315It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021316time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21317appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021318are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21319and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21320follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21321request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21322in the logs.
21323
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021324As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21325frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21326an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21327
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021328 Example :
21329 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21330 listen proxy-out
21331 mode http
21332 option httplog
21333 option logasap
21334 log global
21335 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21336
21337 # log the name of the virtual server
21338 capture request header Host len 20
21339
21340 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21341 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21342
21343 # log the beginning of the referrer
21344 capture request header Referer len 20
21345
21346 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21347 capture response header Server len 20
21348
21349 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21350 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021352 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021353 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21354
21355 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21356 capture response header Via len 20
21357
21358 # log the URL location during a redirection
21359 capture response header Location len 20
21360
21361 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21362 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21363 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21364 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21365 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21366
21367 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21368 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21369 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21370 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021371 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021372
21373 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21374 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21375 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21376 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21377 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021378 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021379
21380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213818.9. Examples of logs
21382---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021383
21384These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21385them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21386reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21387
21388 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21389 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21390 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21391
21392 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21393 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21394
21395 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21396 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21397 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21398
21399 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21400 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21401
21402 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21403 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21404 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21405
21406 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021407 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021408 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21409 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21410
21411 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21412 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21413 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21414
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021415 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21416 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21417 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21418 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021419 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021420 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021421
21422 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021423 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021424
21425 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21426 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21427 Nothing was sent to any server.
21428
21429 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21430 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21431
21432 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21433 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021434 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021435 send a 408 return code to the client.
21436
21437 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21438 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21439
21440 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21441 5 seconds ("c----").
21442
21443 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21444 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021445 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021446
21447 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021448 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021449 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21450 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21451 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21452 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21453 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021454
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021455
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200214569. Supported filters
21457--------------------
21458
21459Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21460accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21461unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21462
21463See also : "filter"
21464
214659.1. Trace
21466----------
21467
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021468filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021469
21470 Arguments:
21471 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21472 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21473
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021474 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021475
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021476 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021477 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21478 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21479 amount of the parsed data.
21480
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021481 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021482
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021483This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21484callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21485information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21486filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21487
21488Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21489tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21490a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21491
21492
214939.2. HTTP compression
21494---------------------
21495
21496filter compression
21497
21498The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21499keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021500when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21501fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21502done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21503explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21504filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21505listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21506order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021507
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021508See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21509 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021510
21511
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200215129.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21513--------------------------------------------
21514
21515filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21516
21517 Arguments :
21518
21519 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21520 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21521 parsed.
21522
21523 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21524 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21525 part must be placed in its own scope.
21526
21527The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21528external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021529streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021530exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21531also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21532
21533SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21534the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21535
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021536For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021537"doc/SPOE.txt".
21538
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100215399.4. Cache
21540----------
21541
21542filter cache <name>
21543
21544 Arguments :
21545
21546 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21547
21548The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21549"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021550cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021551other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21552case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21553is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21554filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021555listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21556order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021557
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021558See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21559 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21560
21561
215629.5. Fcgi-app
21563-------------
21564
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021565filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021566
21567 Arguments :
21568
21569 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21570
21571The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21572request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21573reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21574used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21575implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21576used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21577fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21578used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21579order.
21580
21581See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21582 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21583
21584
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100215859.6. OpenTracing
21586----------------
21587
21588The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21589HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21590of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21591Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21592
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021593This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021594
21595The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21596HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21597participates in the work of HAProxy.
21598
21599filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21600
21601 Arguments :
21602
21603 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21604 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21605 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21606 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21607 OpenTracing filters.
21608
21609 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21610 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21611 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21612 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21613 filter must have its own scope defined.
21614
21615More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021616of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021617
21618
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002161910. FastCGI applications
21620-------------------------
21621
21622HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21623feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21624the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21625FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21626servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21627FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21628backend.
21629
21630HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21631application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21632connection.
21633
2163410.1. Setup
21635-----------
21636
2163710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21638--------------------------
21639
21640fcgi-app <name>
21641 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21642 document root must be defined.
21643
21644acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21645 Declare or complete an access list.
21646
21647 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21648 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21649 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21650 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21651 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21652
21653docroot <path>
21654 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21655 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21656 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21657
21658index <script-name>
21659 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21660 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21661 is an optional setting.
21662
21663 Example :
21664 index index.php
21665
21666log-stderr global
21667log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021668 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021669 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21670
21671 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21672 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21673
21674pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21675 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21676 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21677 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21678
21679 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21680 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21681 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21682 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21683
21684 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21685 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21686
21687path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021688 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021689 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21690 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21691 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21692 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21693 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21694 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21695 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021696
21697 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021698 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021699 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21700 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21701 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21702 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021703
21704 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021705 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21706 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021707
21708option get-values
21709no option get-values
21710 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21711
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021712 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021713 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21714
21715 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21716 application will accept.
21717
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021718 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21719 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021720
21721 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021722 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021723 option is disabled.
21724
21725 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21726 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21727 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21728 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21729 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21730 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21731
21732option keep-conn
21733no option keep-conn
21734 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21735 sending a response.
21736
21737 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21738 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21739
21740option max-reqs <reqs>
21741 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21742 accept.
21743
21744 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21745 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21746 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21747 to 1.
21748
21749option mpxs-conns
21750no option mpxs-conns
21751 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21752
21753 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21754 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21755
21756set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21757 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21758 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21759 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21760 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21761
21762 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21763 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21764 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21765
21766 Example :
21767 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21768 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21769
21770 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21771
21772
2177310.1.2. Proxy section
21774---------------------
21775
21776use-fcgi-app <name>
21777 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21778
21779 Arguments :
21780 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21781
21782 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21783 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21784 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21785 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21786 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21787
21788 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21789 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21790 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21791 application are evaluated.
21792
21793
2179410.1.3. Example
21795---------------
21796
21797 frontend front-http
21798 mode http
21799 bind *:80
21800 bind *:
21801
21802 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21803 default_backend back-static
21804
21805 backend back-static
21806 mode http
21807 server www A.B.C.D:80
21808
21809 backend back-dynamic
21810 mode http
21811 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21812 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21813
21814 fcgi-app php-fpm
21815 log-stderr global
21816 option keep-conn
21817
21818 docroot /var/www/my-app
21819 index index.php
21820 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21821
21822
2182310.2. Default parameters
21824------------------------
21825
21826A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21827the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021828script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021829applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21830
21831 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21832 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21833 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21834 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21835 | | |
21836 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21837 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21838 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21839 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21840 | | application. |
21841 | | |
21842 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21843 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21844 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21845 | | |
21846 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21847 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21848 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21849 | | the application's configuration. |
21850 | | |
21851 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21852 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21853 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21854 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21855 | | |
21856 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21857 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21858 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21859 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21860 | | be defined. |
21861 | | |
21862 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21863 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21864 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21865 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21866 | | is not set too. |
21867 | | |
21868 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21869 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21870 | | set. |
21871 | | |
21872 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21873 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21874 | | the request. |
21875 | | |
21876 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21877 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21878 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21879 | | |
21880 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21881 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21882 | | script to process the request. |
21883 | | |
21884 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21885 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21886 | | |
21887 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21888 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21889 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21890 | | |
21891 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21892 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21893 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21894 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21895 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21896 | | |
21897 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21898 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21899 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21900 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21901 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21902 | | side. |
21903 | | |
21904 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21905 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21906 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21907 | | connected to. |
21908 | | |
21909 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21910 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21911 | | |
21912 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020021913 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
21914 | | current HAProxy version. |
21915 | | |
21916 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021917 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21918 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21919 | | |
21920 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21921
21922
2192310.3. Limitations
21924------------------
21925
21926The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21927way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21928during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21929establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21930application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21931or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21932message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21933these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21934and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21935
21936Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21937request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21938requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21939
21940About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21941into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21942fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21943"http-request" ones.
21944
21945Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21946FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21947processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21948must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21949here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021950
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021951
2195211. Address formats
21953-------------------
21954
21955Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21956address.
21957
21958This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21959The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21960of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21961equivalent is '::'.
21962
21963Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21964is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21965
21966This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21967family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21968
21969Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21970configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21971use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21972'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21973
21974Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21975socket type and the transport method.
21976
21977
2197811.1 Address family prefixes
21979----------------------------
21980
21981'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21982
21983'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21984 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21985 listening.
21986
21987'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21988 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21989 on the statement using this address, a port or
21990 a port range may or must be specified.
21991
21992'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21993 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21994 using this address, a port or a port range
21995 may or must be specified.
21996
21997'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21998 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21999 using this address, a port or a port range
22000 may or must be specified.
22001
22002'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22003 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22004 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22005 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22006 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22007 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22008
22009'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22010 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22011 start by slash '/'.
22012
22013
2201411.2 Socket type prefixes
22015-------------------------
22016
22017Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22018type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22019this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22020This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22021but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22022
22023Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22024instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22025
22026If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22027they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22028report this to the maintainers.
22029
22030'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22031 to "stream"
22032
22033'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22034 to "datagram".
22035
22036
2203711.3 Protocol prefixes
22038----------------------
22039
22040'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22041 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22042 socket type and transport method is forced to
22043 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22044 this address, a port or a port range can or
22045 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22046 of 'stream+ip@'.
22047
22048'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22049 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22050 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22051 statement using this address, a port or port
22052 range can or must be specified.
22053 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22054
22055'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22056 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22057 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22058 statement using this address, a port or port
22059 range can or must be specified.
22060 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22061
22062'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22063 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22064 socket type and transport method is forced to
22065 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22066 this address, a port or a port range can or
22067 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22068 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22069
22070'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22071 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22072 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22073 the statement using this address, a port or
22074 port range can or must be specified.
22075 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22076
22077'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22078 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22079 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22080 the statement using this address, a port or
22081 port range can or must be specified.
22082 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22083
22084'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22085 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22086 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22087
22088'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22089 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22090 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22091
22092In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22093QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022095/*
22096 * Local variables:
22097 * fill-column: 79
22098 * End:
22099 */